blob: b814de90523544aa4ab5288daabab286ee2e3fe1 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100489 - tune.lua.forced-yield
490 - tune.lua.session-timeout
491 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100492 - tune.maxaccept
493 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200494 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200495 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100496 - tune.rcvbuf.client
497 - tune.rcvbuf.server
498 - tune.sndbuf.client
499 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100500 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100501 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200502 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100503 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200504 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100505 - tune.zlib.memlevel
506 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100507
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508 * Debugging
509 - debug
510 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511
512
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005133.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200514------------------------------------
515
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200516ca-base <dir>
517 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200518 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
519 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200520
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200521chroot <jail dir>
522 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
523 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
524 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
525 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
526 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
527 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100528
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100529cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
530 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
531 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
532 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100533 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
534 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
535 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
536 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
537 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
538 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
539 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
540 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
541 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
542 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100543
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200544crt-base <dir>
545 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
546 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
547 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
548
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549daemon
550 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
551 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
552 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
553
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900554external-check
555 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
556 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
557 See "option external-check".
558
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200559gid <number>
560 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
561 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
562 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100563 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
564 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100566
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567group <group name>
568 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
569 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100570
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200571log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
573 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100574 configured with "log global".
575
576 <address> can be one of:
577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100578 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100579 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
580 port).
581
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100582 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
583 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
584 port).
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
587 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
588 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
589 writeable).
590
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100591 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
592 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
593 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
594 in Bourne shell.
595
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200596 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
597 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
598 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
599 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
600 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
601 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
602 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
603 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
604 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
605 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
606 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
607
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100608 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609
610 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
611 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
612 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
613
614 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200615 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
616 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
617 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
618 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
619 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
620 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200622 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100624log-send-hostname [<string>]
625 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
626 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
627 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
628 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
629 the logs.
630
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000631log-tag <string>
632 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
633 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
634 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100635 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000636
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100637lua-load <file>
638 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
639 used multiple times.
640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641nbproc <number>
642 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
643 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
644 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
645 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
646 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
647
648pidfile <pidfile>
649 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
650 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
651 starting the process. See also "daemon".
652
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200654 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
655 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
656 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
657 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
658 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
659 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100660 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200661 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
662 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200663
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100664ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
666 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300667 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100668 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
669 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
670 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
671 "bind" keyword for more information.
672
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100673ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
674 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
675 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
676 keyword to see available options.
677
678 Example:
679 global
680 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
681
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100682ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
684 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300685 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100686 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
687 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
688 information.
689
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100690ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
691 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
692 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
693 keyword to see available options.
694
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100695ssl-server-verify [none|required]
696 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
697 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
698 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
699
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200700stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
701 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
702 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
703 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
704 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200705
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200706 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
707 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
708 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200709
710stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
711 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
712 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100713 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200714
715stats maxconn <connections>
716 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
717 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719uid <number>
720 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
721 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
722 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
723 one. See also "gid" and "user".
724
725ulimit-n <number>
726 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
727 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
728 option.
729
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100730unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
731 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
732
733 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
734 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
735 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
736 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
737 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
738 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
739 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
740 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
741 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
742 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
743
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200744user <user name>
745 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
746 See also "uid" and "group".
747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200748node <name>
749 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
750
751 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
752 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
753 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
754 traffic.
755
756description <text>
757 Add a text that describes the instance.
758
759 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
760 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
761 "<" and ">" characters.
762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007643.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765-----------------------
766
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200767max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
768 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
769 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
770 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
771 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
772 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
773 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
774 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
775 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777maxconn <number>
778 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
779 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
780 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200781 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
782 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
783 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
784 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100785 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
786 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
787 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
788 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
789 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200791maxconnrate <number>
792 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
793 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
794 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
795 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
796 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
797 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
798 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
799 fairness.
800
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100801maxcomprate <number>
802 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300803 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100804 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
805 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
806 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
807 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
808 default value.
809
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100810maxcompcpuusage <number>
811 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
812 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
813 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
814 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
815 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
816 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
817 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
818 process down and from introducing high latencies.
819
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100820maxpipes <number>
821 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
822 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
823 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
824 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
825 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
826 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
827
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200828maxsessrate <number>
829 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
830 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
831 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
832 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
833 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
834 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
835 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
836 fairness.
837
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200838maxsslconn <number>
839 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
840 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
841 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
842 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
843 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
844 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
845 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100846 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
847 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
848 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
849 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
850 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
851 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
852 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200853
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200854maxsslrate <number>
855 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
856 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
857 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
858 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
859 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
860 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
861 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
862 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
863 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
864 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
865
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100866maxzlibmem <number>
867 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
868 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
869 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100870 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
871 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
872 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
873
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200874noepoll
875 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
876 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100877 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200878
879nokqueue
880 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
881 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
882 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
883
884nopoll
885 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
886 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100887 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100888 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200889
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100890nosplice
891 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
892 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
893 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100894 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100895 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
896 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
897 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
898 "option splice-response".
899
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300900nogetaddrinfo
901 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
902 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
903
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200904spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900905 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
906 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
907 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
908 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
909 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
910 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200911
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100912tune.buffers.limit <number>
913 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
914 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
915 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
916 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
917 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
918 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
919 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
920 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
921 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
922 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
923 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
924 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
925 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
926 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
927 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
928
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100929tune.buffers.reserve <number>
930 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
931 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
932 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
933 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
934
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200935tune.bufsize <number>
936 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
937 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
938 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
939 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
940 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
941 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
942 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
943 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400944 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
945 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
946 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200947
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200948tune.chksize <number>
949 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
950 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
951 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
952 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
953 checks whenever possible.
954
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100955tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
956 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
957 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
958 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
959 this value. The default value is 1.
960
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100961tune.http.cookielen <number>
962 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
963 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
964 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
965 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
966 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
967 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
968 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
969 to change this value.
970
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200971tune.http.maxhdr <number>
972 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
973 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
974 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
975 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
976 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
977 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
978 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
979 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
980 limit too high.
981
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100982tune.idletimer <timeout>
983 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
984 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
985 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
986 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
987 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
988 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
989 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
990 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
991 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100993tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
994 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
995 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
996 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
997 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
998 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
999 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1000 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1001
1002tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1003 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
1004 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout has a
1005 priority over other timeouts. For example, if this timeout is set to 4s and
1006 you run a 5s sleep, the code will be interrupted with an error after waiting
1007 4s.
1008
1009tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1010 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1011 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1012 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1013 check servers.
1014
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001015tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001016 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1017 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1018 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1019 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1020 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1021 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1022 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1023 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1024 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1025 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001026
1027tune.maxpollevents <number>
1028 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1029 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1030 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1031 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1032 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1033
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001034tune.maxrewrite <number>
1035 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1036 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1037 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1038 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1039 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1040 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1041 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1042 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1043 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1044 bufsize.
1045
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001046tune.pipesize <number>
1047 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1048 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1049 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1050 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1051 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1052 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1053
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001054tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1055tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1056 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1057 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1058 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1059 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1060 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1061 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1062 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1063
1064tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1065tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1066 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1067 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1068 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1069 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1070 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1071 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1072 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1073 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1074 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1075 notifying haproxy again.
1076
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001077tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001078 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1079 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1080 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001081 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001082 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1083 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1084 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1085 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1086 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001087 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1088 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001089
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001090tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1091 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1092 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1093 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1094 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1095 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1096 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1097
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001098tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1099 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001100 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001101 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1102 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1103 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1104 being used for too long.
1105
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001106tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1107 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1108 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1109 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1110 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1111 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1112 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1113 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1114 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1115 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1116 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001117 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1118 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001119
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001120tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1121 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1122 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1123 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1124 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1125 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1126 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1127 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1128 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1129
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001130tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1131 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001132 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001133 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1134 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1135 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1136
1137tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1138 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1139 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1140 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1141 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011433.3. Debugging
1144--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001145
1146debug
1147 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1148 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1149 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1150 system startup.
1151
1152quiet
1153 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1154 line argument "-q".
1155
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011573.4. Userlists
1158--------------
1159It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1160http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1161it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1162
1163userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001164 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001165 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1166
1167group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001168 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001169 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1170 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1171
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001172user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1173 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001174 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1175 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001176 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1177 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001178 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001179 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001180
1181
1182 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001183 userlist L1
1184 group G1 users tiger,scott
1185 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001186
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001187 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1188 user scott insecure-password elgato
1189 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001190
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001191 userlist L2
1192 group G1
1193 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001194
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001195 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1196 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1197 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001198
1199 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001201
12023.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001203----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001204It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1205haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1206pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1207identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1208or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1209Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1210known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1211the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1212process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1213during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1214tables.
1215
1216peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001217 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001218 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1219
1220peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1221 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1222 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1223 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1224 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1225 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1226 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1227
1228 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1229 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1230
1231 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1232 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1233 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1234 across all peers.
1235
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001236 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1237 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1238 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1239
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001240 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001241 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001242 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1243 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1244 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001245
1246 backend mybackend
1247 mode tcp
1248 balance roundrobin
1249 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1250 stick on src
1251
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001252 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1253 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001254
1255
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090012563.6. Mailers
1257------------
1258It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1259If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1260in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1261
1262mailer <mailersect>
1263 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1264 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1265
1266mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1267 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1268
1269 Example:
1270 mailers mymailers
1271 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1272 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1273
1274 backend mybackend
1275 mode tcp
1276 balance roundrobin
1277
1278 email-alert mailers mymailers
1279 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1280 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1281
1282 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1283 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1284
1285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012864. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001287----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001289Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1290 - defaults <name>
1291 - frontend <name>
1292 - backend <name>
1293 - listen <name>
1294
1295A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1296its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1297section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001298section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001299
1300A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1301connections.
1302
1303A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1304to forward incoming connections.
1305
1306A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1307parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1310'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1311case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1312
1313Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1314logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1315proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1316However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1317name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1318
1319Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1320and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001321bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001322protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1323modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1324arbitrary criteria.
1325
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001326In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1327a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1328the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1329
1330 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1331 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1332 between responses and new requests.
1333
1334 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1335 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1336 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1337 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1338
1339 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1340 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1341 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1342
1343 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1344 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1345 client-facing connection remains open.
1346
1347 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1348 after the end of the response.
1349
1350The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1351frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1352following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1353weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1354
1355 Backend mode
1356
1357 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1358 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1359 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1360 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1361 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1362 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1363 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1364 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1365 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1366 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1367 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001369
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013714.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1372--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001373
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001374The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1375limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1376they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1377limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001378marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001379option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001380and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1381with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1382specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001383
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001384
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001385 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1386------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1387acl - X X X
1388appsession - - X X
1389backlog X X X -
1390balance X - X X
1391bind - X X -
1392bind-process X X X X
1393block - X X X
1394capture cookie - X X -
1395capture request header - X X -
1396capture response header - X X -
1397clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001398compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1400cookie X - X X
1401default-server X - X X
1402default_backend X X X -
1403description - X X X
1404disabled X X X X
1405dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001406email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001407email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001408email-alert mailers X X X X
1409email-alert myhostname X X X X
1410email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001411enabled X X X X
1412errorfile X X X X
1413errorloc X X X X
1414errorloc302 X X X X
1415-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1416errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001417force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418fullconn X - X X
1419grace X X X X
1420hash-type X - X X
1421http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001422http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001423http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001424http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001425http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001426http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001427id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001428ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001429log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001430log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001431log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001432max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001433maxconn X X X -
1434mode X X X X
1435monitor fail - X X -
1436monitor-net X X X -
1437monitor-uri X X X -
1438option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1439option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1440option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1441option allbackups (*) X - X X
1442option checkcache (*) X - X X
1443option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1444option contstats (*) X X X -
1445option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1446option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1447option forceclose (*) X X X X
1448-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1449option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001450option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001451option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001452option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001453option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001454option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001455option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1456option httpchk X - X X
1457option httpclose (*) X X X X
1458option httplog X X X X
1459option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001460option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001461option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001462option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001463option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1464option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1465option logasap (*) X X X -
1466option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001467option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001468option nolinger (*) X X X X
1469option originalto X X X X
1470option persist (*) X - X X
1471option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001472option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001473option smtpchk X - X X
1474option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1475option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1476option splice-request (*) X X X X
1477option splice-response (*) X X X X
1478option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1479option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1480-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001481option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001482option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1483option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1484option tcpka X X X X
1485option tcplog X X X X
1486option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001487external-check command X - X X
1488external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001489persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1490rate-limit sessions X X X -
1491redirect - X X X
1492redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1493redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1494reqadd - X X X
1495reqallow - X X X
1496reqdel - X X X
1497reqdeny - X X X
1498reqiallow - X X X
1499reqidel - X X X
1500reqideny - X X X
1501reqipass - X X X
1502reqirep - X X X
1503reqisetbe - X X X
1504reqitarpit - X X X
1505reqpass - X X X
1506reqrep - X X X
1507-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1508reqsetbe - X X X
1509reqtarpit - X X X
1510retries X - X X
1511rspadd - X X X
1512rspdel - X X X
1513rspdeny - X X X
1514rspidel - X X X
1515rspideny - X X X
1516rspirep - X X X
1517rsprep - X X X
1518server - - X X
1519source X - X X
1520srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001521stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001522stats auth X - X X
1523stats enable X - X X
1524stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001525stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001526stats realm X - X X
1527stats refresh X - X X
1528stats scope X - X X
1529stats show-desc X - X X
1530stats show-legends X - X X
1531stats show-node X - X X
1532stats uri X - X X
1533-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1534stick match - - X X
1535stick on - - X X
1536stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001537stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001538stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001539tcp-check connect - - X X
1540tcp-check expect - - X X
1541tcp-check send - - X X
1542tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001543tcp-request connection - X X -
1544tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001545tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001546tcp-response content - - X X
1547tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001548timeout check X - X X
1549timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001550timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001551timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1552timeout connect X - X X
1553timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1554timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1555timeout http-request X X X X
1556timeout queue X - X X
1557timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001558timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001559timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1560timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001561timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001562transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001563unique-id-format X X X -
1564unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001565use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001566use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001567------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1568 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015714.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1572---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001573
1574This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1575
1576
1577acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1578 Declare or complete an access list.
1579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1580 no | yes | yes | yes
1581 Example:
1582 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1583 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1584 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001586 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001587
1588
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001589appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1590 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1593 no | no | yes | yes
1594 Arguments :
1595 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1596 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1597
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001598 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001599 checked in each cookie value.
1600
1601 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1602 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1603 milliseconds.
1604
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001605 request-learn
1606 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1607 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1608 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1609 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1610 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1611 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1612
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001613 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1614 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1615 data following this prefix.
1616
1617 Example :
1618 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1619
1620 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1621 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1622
1623 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1624 2 modes are currently supported :
1625 - path-parameters :
1626 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1627 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1628 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1629 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1630 - query-string :
1631 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1632 query string.
1633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1635 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1636 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1637 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001638 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1639 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1640 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1642 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1643
1644 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1645
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001646 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1647 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1648 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 Example :
1651 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1652
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001653 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1654 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001655
1656
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001657backlog <conns>
1658 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1660 yes | yes | yes | no
1661 Arguments :
1662 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1663 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001664 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001665
1666 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1667 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1668 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1669 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1670 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1671 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1672 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1673 backlog parameter.
1674
1675 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1676 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1677 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1678
1679 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1680
1681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001682balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001683balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001684 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1686 yes | no | yes | yes
1687 Arguments :
1688 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1689 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1690 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1691 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1692
1693 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1694 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1695 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1696 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001697 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001698 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001699 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1700 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1701 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1702 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1703 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1704 it, so that you don't worry.
1705
1706 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1707 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1708 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1709 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1710 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1711 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1712 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1713 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001714
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001715 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1716 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1717 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1718 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1719 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1720 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1721 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1722 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1723
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001724 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001725 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001726 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1727 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001728 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001729 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1730 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1731 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1732 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1733 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001734 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1735 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1736 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1737 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1738 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1739 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001740
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001741 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1742 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1743 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1744 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1745 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1746 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1747 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1748 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001749 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001750 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001751 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1752 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1753 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001755 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1756 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1757 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1758 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1759 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1760 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1761 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1762 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1763 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1764 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1765 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1766 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001768 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001769 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1770 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1771 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1772 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1773 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1774 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1775 URIs start with a leading "/".
1776
1777 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1778 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1779 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1780 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001782 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001783 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1784
1785 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001786 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1787 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001788 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1789 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1790 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1791 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001792 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001793 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1794 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001795
1796 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1797 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1798 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1799 server will receive the request.
1800
1801 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1802 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1803 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1804 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1805 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001806 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1807 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1808 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001809
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001810 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1811 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1812 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1813 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1814 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001816 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001817 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1818 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1819 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1820
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001821 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1822 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1823 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1824
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001825 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001826 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001827 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1828 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1829 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1830 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1831 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1832 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001833 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001834 used instead.
1835
1836 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1837 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1838 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1839 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1840
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001841 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1842 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1843 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1844
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001845 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001848 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1849 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001850
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001851 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1852 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1853 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001854
1855 Examples :
1856 balance roundrobin
1857 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001858 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001859 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1860 balance hdr(host)
1861 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001862
1863 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1864 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001866 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001867 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1868 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1869 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1870 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1871
1872 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1873 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1874 defaults to 16 kB.
1875
1876 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1877 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1878
1879 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1880 Round Robin.
1881
1882 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1883 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1884 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1885 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1886
1887 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1888
1889 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001890 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001891 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1892 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1893 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001895 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1896 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001897
1898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001899bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1900bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001901 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1903 no | yes | yes | no
1904 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001905 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1906 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1907 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1908 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001909 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001910 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1911 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1912 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1913 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1914 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1915 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1916 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001917 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1918 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1919 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1920 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1921 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1922 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1923 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001924 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1925 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1926 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001927 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1928 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1929 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1930 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001931
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001932 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1933 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001934 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1935 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1936 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001937 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1938 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1939 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1940 the range.
1941
1942 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1943 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1944 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1945 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1946 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1947 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1948 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001949 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001950 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001951
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001952 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1953 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1954 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1955 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1956 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1957 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1958 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1959 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1960
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001961 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1962 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1963 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1964 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001966 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1967 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1968 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1969 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1970 in a frontend.
1971
1972 Example :
1973 listen http_proxy
1974 bind :80,:443
1975 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001976 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001977
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001978 listen http_https_proxy
1979 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001980 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001981
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001982 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1983 bind ipv6@:80
1984 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1985 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1986
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001987 listen external_bind_app1
1988 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1989
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001990 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001991 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001992
1993
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001994bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001995 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1997 yes | yes | yes | yes
1998 Arguments :
1999 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2000 may be used to override a default value.
2001
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002002 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002003 option may be combined with other numbers.
2004
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002005 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002006 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2007 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2008 missing from all processes.
2009
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002010 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002011 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002012 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2013 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2014 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2015 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002016
2017 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2018 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2019 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2020 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2021 and 'even' instances.
2022
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002023 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2024 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2025 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2026 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002027
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002028 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2029 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2030
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002031 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2032 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2033 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2034
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002035 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2036 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2037
2038 Example :
2039 listen app_ip1
2040 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002041 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002042
2043 listen app_ip2
2044 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002045 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002046
2047 listen management
2048 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002049 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002050
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002051 listen management
2052 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2053 bind-process 1-4
2054
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002055 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002056
2057
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058block { if | unless } <condition>
2059 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2061 no | yes | yes | yes
2062
2063 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2064 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002065 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002066 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2068 "block" statements per instance.
2069
2070 Example:
2071 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2072 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2073 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2074 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002076 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002077
2078
2079capture cookie <name> len <length>
2080 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2082 no | yes | yes | no
2083 Arguments :
2084 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2085 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2086 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2087 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2088 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2089
2090 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2091 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2092 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2093 right if it exceeds <length>.
2094
2095 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2096 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2097 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2098 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2099
2100 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2101 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2102 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2103
2104 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2105 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2106 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002107 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2108 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2109 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002110
2111 Example:
2112 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2113
2114 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002115 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116
2117
2118capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002119 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2121 no | yes | yes | no
2122 Arguments :
2123 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002124 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002125 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2126 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2127 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2128
2129 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2130 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2131 it exceeds <length>.
2132
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002133 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2135 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002136 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2137 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2138 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2139 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002140 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002141 environments to find where the request came from.
2142
2143 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2144 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2145 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2146 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002148 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2149 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2150 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2151 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2152 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153
2154 Example:
2155 capture request header Host len 15
2156 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2157 capture request header Referrer len 15
2158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002159 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160 about logging.
2161
2162
2163capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002164 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2166 no | yes | yes | no
2167 Arguments :
2168 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002169 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2171 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2172 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2173
2174 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2175 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2176 it exceeds <length>.
2177
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002178 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2180 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2181 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002182 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2183 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2184 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2185 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002187 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2188 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2189 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2190 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2191 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002192
2193 Example:
2194 capture response header Content-length len 9
2195 capture response header Location len 15
2196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002197 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198 about logging.
2199
2200
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002201clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002202 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2204 yes | yes | yes | no
2205 Arguments :
2206 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2207 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2208 as explained at the top of this document.
2209
2210 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2211 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2212 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2213 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2214 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2215 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2216 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2217 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002218 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2220 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2221
2222 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2223 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2224 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2225 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2226 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2227 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2228
2229 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2230 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2231
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002232 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2233 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002234
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002235compression algo <algorithm> ...
2236compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002237compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002238 Enable HTTP compression.
2239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2240 yes | yes | yes | yes
2241 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002242 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2243 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2244 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2245
2246 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002247 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002248 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2249 data.
2250
2251 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2252 support for zlib was built in.
2253
2254 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2255 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2256 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2257 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2258 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2259 in.
2260
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002261 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002262 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002263 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2264 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2265 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2266 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2267 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002268
2269 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2270 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2271 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2272 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2273 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002274 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2275 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2276 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2277 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2278 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002279 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2280 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002281
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002282 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002283 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2284 "Accept-Encoding" header
2285 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002286 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002287 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2288 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002289 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2290 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2291 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2292 "multipart"
2293 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2294 header
2295 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2296 and later
2297 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2298 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002299
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002300 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2301 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002302
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002303 Examples :
2304 compression algo gzip
2305 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002306
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002307contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2310 yes | no | yes | yes
2311 Arguments :
2312 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2314 as explained at the top of this document.
2315
2316 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002317 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002318 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002319 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2320 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2321 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2322 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2323
2324 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2325 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2326 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2327 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2328 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2329 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2330
2331 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2332 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2333 instead.
2334
2335 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2336 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2337
2338
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002339cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002340 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2341 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2344 yes | no | yes | yes
2345 Arguments :
2346 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2347 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2348 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2349 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2350 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2351 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2352 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2353 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2354 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2355
2356 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2357 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2358 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2359 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2360 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2361 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2362 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2363 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2364 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2365 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2366 "insert" and "prefix".
2367
2368 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002369 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002370
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002371 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002372 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2373 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2374 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2375 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2376 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2377 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2378 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2379 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2380 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2381 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
2383 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2384 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2385 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2386 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2387 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2388 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2389 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2390 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2391 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2392 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002393 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2394 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2395 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002397 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2398 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2399 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002400 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2401 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2402 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2403 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002404 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2405 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2406 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
2408 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2409 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2410 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2411 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2412 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2413 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2414 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2415 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2416 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2417
2418 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2419 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2420 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2421 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2422 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2423 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2424 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2425 persistence cookie in the cache.
2426 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2427
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002428 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2429 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2430 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2431 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2432 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2433 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2434 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2435 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2436 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2437 they logout.
2438
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002439 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2440 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2441 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2442 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2443
2444 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2445 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2446 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2447 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2448 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2449 this attribute.
2450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002451 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002452 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002453 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2454 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2455 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2456 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2457 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2458 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002459
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002460 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2461 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2462 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2463 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2464 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2465 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2466 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2467 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2468 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2469 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2470 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2471 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2472 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2473 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2474 the site.
2475
2476 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2477 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2478 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2479 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2480 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2481 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2482 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2483 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2484 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2485 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2486 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2487 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2488 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2489 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2490 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2491 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2494 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2495 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2496 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002498 Examples :
2499 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2500 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2501 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002502 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002504 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002505 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002508default-server [param*]
2509 Change default options for a server in a backend
2510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2511 yes | no | yes | yes
2512 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002513 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2514 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2515 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2516 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002517
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002518 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002519 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2520
2521 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002522
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002524default_backend <backend>
2525 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 yes | yes | yes | no
2528 Arguments :
2529 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2530
2531 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2532 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2533 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2534 will catch all undetermined requests.
2535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536 Example :
2537
2538 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2539 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2540 default_backend dynamic
2541
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002542 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002544
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002545description <string>
2546 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 no | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments : string
2550
2551 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2552 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2553 it describes.
2554 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2555
2556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557disabled
2558 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 yes | yes | yes | yes
2561 Arguments : none
2562
2563 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2564 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2565 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2566 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2567 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2568 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2569 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2570
2571 See also : "enabled"
2572
2573
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002574dispatch <address>:<port>
2575 Set a default server address
2576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2577 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002578 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002579
2580 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2581 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2582 during start-up.
2583
2584 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2585 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2586 possible with normal servers.
2587
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002588 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002589 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2590 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2591 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2592 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2593
2594 See also : "server"
2595
2596
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597enabled
2598 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2600 yes | yes | yes | yes
2601 Arguments : none
2602
2603 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2604 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2605
2606 See also : "disabled"
2607
2608
2609errorfile <code> <file>
2610 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | yes | yes | yes
2613 Arguments :
2614 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002615 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616
2617 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002618 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002620 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2621 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622
2623 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2624 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2625 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2626
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002627 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2628
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002629 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2630 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2631 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2632 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2633
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002634 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2635 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2636 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2637 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2638 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2639 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2642 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2643 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002644 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2646
2647 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2648
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002649 Example :
2650 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002651 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002652 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2653 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2654
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002655
2656errorloc <code> <url>
2657errorloc302 <code> <url>
2658 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2660 yes | yes | yes | yes
2661 Arguments :
2662 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002663 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002664
2665 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2666 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2667 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2668 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2669 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2670
2671 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2672 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2673 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2674
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002675 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2678 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2679 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2680 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2681 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2682 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2683 request.
2684
2685 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2686
2687
2688errorloc303 <code> <url>
2689 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2691 yes | yes | yes | yes
2692 Arguments :
2693 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2694 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2695
2696 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2697 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2698 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2699 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2700 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2701
2702 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2703 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2704 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2705
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002706 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002708 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2709 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2710 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2711 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002712 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713
2714 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2715
2716
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002717email-alert from <emailaddr>
2718 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
2719 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
2720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 yes | yes | yes | yes
2722
2723 Arguments :
2724
2725 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
2726
2727 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2728 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2729
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002730 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2731 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
2732
2733
2734email-alert level <level>
2735 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
2736 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
2737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2738 yes | yes | yes | yes
2739
2740 Arguments :
2741
2742 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
2743 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2744 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
2745
2746 By default level is alert
2747
2748 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2749 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2750 for the proxy.
2751
2752 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
2753 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002754 section 3.6 about mailers.
2755
2756
2757email-alert mailers <mailersect>
2758 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
2759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2760 yes | yes | yes | yes
2761
2762 Arguments :
2763
2764 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
2765
2766 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
2767 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2768
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002769 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
2770 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002771
2772
2773email-alert myhostname <hostname>
2774 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
2775 mailers.
2776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2777 yes | yes | yes | yes
2778
2779 Arguments :
2780
2781 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2782
2783 By default the systems hostname is used.
2784
2785 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
2786 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
2787 for the proxy.
2788
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002789 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
2790 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002791
2792
2793email-alert to <emailaddr>
2794 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
2795 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
2796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2797 yes | yes | yes | yes
2798
2799 Arguments :
2800
2801 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
2802
2803 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
2804 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
2805
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002806 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002807 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
2808
2809
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002810force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2811 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2813 no | yes | yes | yes
2814
2815 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2816 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2817 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2818 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2819 marked down for maintenance operations.
2820
2821 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2822 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2823 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2824 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2825 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2826 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2827 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2828 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2829 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2830
2831 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2832 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2833 is used.
2834
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002835 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002836 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002837
2838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002839fullconn <conns>
2840 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2842 yes | no | yes | yes
2843 Arguments :
2844 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2845 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2846
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002847 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002848 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002849 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002850 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2851 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2852 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2853 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2854 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002855 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002856
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002857 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2858 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002859 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2860 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2861 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002863 Example :
2864 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2865 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2866 # connections.
2867 backend dynamic
2868 fullconn 10000
2869 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2870 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2871
2872 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2873
2874
2875grace <time>
2876 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002878 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002879 Arguments :
2880 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2881 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2882 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2883
2884 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2885 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002886 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002887 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2888
2889 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2890 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2891 simplify it.
2892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002894hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002895 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2897 yes | no | yes | yes
2898 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002899 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2900 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002901
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002902 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2903 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2904 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2905 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2906 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2907 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2908 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2909 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2910 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2911 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002912
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002913 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2914 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2915 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2916 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2917 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2918 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2919 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2920 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2921 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2922 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2923 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2924 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2925 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002926 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2927 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002928
2929 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2930
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002931 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002932 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2933 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2934 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002935 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2936 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2937 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002938
2939 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2940 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002941 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2942 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2943 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2944 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2945
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002946 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2947 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2948 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2949 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2950 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2951 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2952 parameter.
2953
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01002954 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
2955 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
2956 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
2957 used on strings.
2958
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002959 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2960
2961 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2962 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2963 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2964 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2965 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2966 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2967 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2968 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2969 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2970 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2971 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2972 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002973
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002974 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2975 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2976 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002977
2978 See also : "balance", "server"
2979
2980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981http-check disable-on-404
2982 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002984 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985 Arguments : none
2986
2987 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2988 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2989 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2990 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2991 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2992 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2993 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2994 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002995 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2996 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2997 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2998
2999 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3000
3001
3002http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003003 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003005 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003006 Arguments :
3007 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3008 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003009 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003010 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3011 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3012 details on the supported keywords.
3013
3014 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3015 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3016 with the usual backslash ('\').
3017
3018 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3019 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3020 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3021 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3022 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3023
3024 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003025 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003026 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3027 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3028 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3029
3030 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003031 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003032 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3033 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3034 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3035 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3036
3037 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003038 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003039 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3040 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3041 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3042 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3043 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3044 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3045 trace).
3046
3047 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003049 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3050 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3051 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3052 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3053 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3054 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3055
3056 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3057 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3058 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3059 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3060 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3061 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3062 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3063 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3064
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003065 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3066 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3067 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3068
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003069 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3070 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3071
3072 Examples :
3073 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003074 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003075
3076 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003077 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003078
3079 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003080 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003081
3082 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003083 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003085 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003086
3087
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003088http-check send-state
3089 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3091 yes | no | yes | yes
3092 Arguments : none
3093
3094 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3095 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3096 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3097 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3098 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3099
3100 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3101 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3102 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3103 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3104 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
3105 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3106 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3107 checked in multiple backends.
3108
3109 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3110 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3111
3112 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3113 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3114 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3115 one fails.
3116
3117 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3118 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3119 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3120
3121 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3122 server's queue.
3123
3124 Example of a header received by the application server :
3125 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3126 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3127
3128 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3129
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003130http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003131 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003132 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003133 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3134 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003135 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3136 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003137 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3138 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3139 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003140 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003141 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
3142 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003143 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003144 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003145 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3146
3147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3148 no | yes | yes | yes
3149
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003150 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3151 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3152 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3153 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3154 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003155
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003156 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3157 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3158 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3159
3160 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3161 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3162 are evaluated.
3163
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003164 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3165 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3166 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3167 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3168 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3169 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3170 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3171 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3172 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003173 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003174 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3175
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003176 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3177 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3178 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3179 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3180 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3181
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003182 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3183 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3184 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003185 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3186 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003187
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003188 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3189 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3190 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3191 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3192 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3193 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3194 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3195 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3196
3197 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3198 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3199 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003200 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3201 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003202
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003203 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3204 <name>.
3205
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003206 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3207 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3208 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3209 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3210 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3211 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3212 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3213 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3214
3215 Example:
3216
3217 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3218
3219 applied to:
3220
3221 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3222
3223 outputs:
3224
3225 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3226
3227 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3228
3229 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3230 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3231 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3232 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3233 header.
3234
3235 Example:
3236
3237 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3238
3239 applied to:
3240
3241 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3242
3243 outputs:
3244
3245 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3246
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003247 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3248 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3249 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3250 it.
3251
3252 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3253 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3254 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3255 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3256 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3257 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3258
3259 Example :
3260 # prepend the host name before the path
3261 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3262
3263 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3264 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3265 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3266 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3267 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3268 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3269 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3270 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3271
3272 Example :
3273 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3274 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3275
3276 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3277 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3278 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3279 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3280 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3281 "set-query".
3282
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003283 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3284 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3285 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3286 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3287 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3288 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3289 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3290 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3291
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003292 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3293 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3294 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3295 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3296 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3297 another equipment.
3298
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003299 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3300 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3301 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3302 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3303 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3304 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3305 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3306 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3307
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003308 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3309 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3310 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3311 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3312 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3313 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3314 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3315 admin privileges.
3316
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003317 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3318 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3319 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3320 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3321 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3322 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3323 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3324 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3325
3326 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3327 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3328 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3329 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3330 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3331 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3332
3333 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3334 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3335 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3336 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3337 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3338 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3339
3340 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3341 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3342 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3343 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3344 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3345 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3346 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3347 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3348 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3349
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003350 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3351 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3352 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3353 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3354 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3355 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3356 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3357 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3358 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3359 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3360 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3361 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3362
3363 These actions take one or two arguments :
3364 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3365 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3366 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3367 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3368
3369 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3370 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3371 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3372 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3373
3374 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3375 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3376 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3377 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3378 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3379 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3380 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3381 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3382
3383 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3384 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3385 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3386 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3387 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3388
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003389 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3390 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3391 function is documented in the API documentation.
3392
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003393 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3394
3395 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3396 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3397 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3398 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003399
3400 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003401 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3402 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3403 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003404
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003405 http-request allow if nagios
3406 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3407 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3408 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003409
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003410 Example:
3411 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003412 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003413
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003414 Example:
3415 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3416 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3417 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3418 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3419 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3420 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3421 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3422 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3423 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3424
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003425 Example:
3426 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3427 acl add path /addacl
3428 acl del path /delacl
3429
3430 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3431
3432 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3433 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3434
3435 Example:
3436 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3437 acl setmap path /setmap
3438 acl delmap path /delmap
3439
3440 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3441
3442 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3443 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3444
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003445 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3446 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003447
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003448http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003449 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003450 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3451 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003452 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3453 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3454 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3455 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003456 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
3457 lua <function name>
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003458 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003459 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003460 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3461
3462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3463 no | yes | yes | yes
3464
3465 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3466 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3467 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3468 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3469 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3470 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3471
3472 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3473 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3474 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3475 current section.
3476
3477 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3478 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3479 rules are evaluated.
3480
3481 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3482 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3483 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3484 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3485 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3486 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3487 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3488
3489 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3490 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3491 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3492 external users.
3493
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003494 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3495 <name>.
3496
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003497 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3498 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3499 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3500 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3501 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3502 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3503 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3504 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3505
3506 Example:
3507
3508 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3509
3510 applied to:
3511
3512 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3513
3514 outputs:
3515
3516 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3517
3518 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3519
3520 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3521 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3522 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3523 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3524 header.
3525
3526 Example:
3527
3528 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3529
3530 applied to:
3531
3532 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3533
3534 outputs:
3535
3536 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3537
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003538 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3539 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3540 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3541 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3542 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3543 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3544 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3545 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3546
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003547 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3548 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3549 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3550 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3551 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3552 another equipment.
3553
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003554 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3555 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3556 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3557 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3558 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3559 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3560 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3561 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3562
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003563 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3564 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3565 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3566 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3567 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3568 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3569 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3570 admin privileges.
3571
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003572 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3573 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3574 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3575 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3576 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3577 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3578 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3579 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3580
3581 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3582 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3583 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3584 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3585 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3586 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3587
3588 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3589 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3590 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3591 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3592 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3593 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3594
3595 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3596 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3597 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3598 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3599 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3600 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3601 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3602 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3603 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3604
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003605 - "lua" is used to run a Lua function if the action is executed. The single
3606 parameter is the name of the function to run. The prototype of the
3607 function is documented in the API documentation.
3608
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003609 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3610
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003611 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003612 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3613 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3614 rules.
3615
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003616 Example:
3617 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3618
3619 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3620
3621 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3622 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3623
3624 Example:
3625 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3626
3627 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3628
3629 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3630 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3631
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003632 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3633 ACL usage.
3634
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003635
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003636http-send-name-header [<header>]
3637 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3638
3639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3640 yes | no | yes | yes
3641
3642 Arguments :
3643
3644 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3645
3646 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3647 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3648 is added with the header string proved.
3649
3650 See also : "server"
3651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003652id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003653 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 no | yes | yes | yes
3656 Arguments : none
3657
3658 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3659 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3660 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003661
3662
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003663ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3664 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3665 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 no | yes | yes | yes
3667
3668 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3669 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3670 and running).
3671
3672 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3673 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3674 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003675 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003676 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3677
3678 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3679 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3680
3681 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3682 "unless" condition is met.
3683
3684 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3685
3686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003687log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003688log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003689no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003690 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003693
3694 Prefix :
3695 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3696 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3697 prefix does not allow arguments.
3698
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003699 Arguments :
3700 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3701 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3702 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3703 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3704 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3705 parameter.
3706
3707 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3708 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3709
3710 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3711 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3712 standard syslog port).
3713
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003714 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3715 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3716 standard syslog port).
3717
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003718 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3719 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3720 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3721 appropriately writeable).
3722
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003723 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3724 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3725 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3726 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3727
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003728 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3729 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3730 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3731 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3732 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3733 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3734 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3735 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3736 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3737 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3738 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003740 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3741
3742 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3743 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3744 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3745
3746 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3747 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3748 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003749 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3750 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3751 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3752 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3753 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754
3755 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3756
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003757 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3758 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3759 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003760
3761 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3762 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3763 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3764 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3765
3766 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3767 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003768
3769 Example :
3770 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003771 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3772 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003773 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3774
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003776log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003777 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003780
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003781 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3782 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3783 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3784 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3785 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003786
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003787log-tag <string>
3788 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3790 yes | yes | yes | yes
3791
3792 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3793 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3794 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3795 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3796 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3797 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3798 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3799 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3800 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003801
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003802max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3803 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3804 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3805 yes | no | yes | yes
3806
3807 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3808 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3809 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3810 servers.
3811
3812 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3813 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3814 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3815 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3816 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3817 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3818 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3819 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3820 picking a different server.
3821
3822 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3823 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3824 even if they have to be queued.
3825
3826 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3827 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3828
3829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003830maxconn <conns>
3831 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3833 yes | yes | yes | no
3834 Arguments :
3835 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3836 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3837 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3838 closes.
3839
3840 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3841 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3842 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3843 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3844 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3845 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3846 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3847 properly tuned.
3848
3849 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3850 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3851 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3852
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003853 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3854
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003855 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3856
3857
3858mode { tcp|http|health }
3859 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | yes | yes | yes
3862 Arguments :
3863 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3864 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3865 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3866 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3867
3868 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3869 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3870 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3871 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3872 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3873
3874 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003875 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3876 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3877 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3878 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3879 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3880 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3881 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003882
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003883 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3884 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3885 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003886
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003887 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003888 defaults http_instances
3889 mode http
3890
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003891 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003893
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003894monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003895 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3897 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003898 Arguments :
3899 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3900 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003901 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003902 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3903 backend and its backup.
3904
3905 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3906 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3907 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3908 servers in a list of backends.
3909
3910 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3911 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3912 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3913 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3914 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3915 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3916 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003917 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3918 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003919
3920 Example:
3921 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003922 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003923 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3924 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3925 monitor-uri /site_alive
3926 monitor fail if site_dead
3927
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003928 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003929
3930
3931monitor-net <source>
3932 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | yes | yes | no
3935 Arguments :
3936 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3937 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3938 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3939 followed by a mask.
3940
3941 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3942 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003943 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003944 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3945
3946 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3947 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3948 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3949 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003950 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3951 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3952 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003953
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003954 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3955 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3956 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3957 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3958 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3959 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003960
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003961 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3962 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003964 Example :
3965 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3966 frontend www
3967 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3968
3969 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3970
3971
3972monitor-uri <uri>
3973 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3975 yes | yes | yes | no
3976 Arguments :
3977 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3978 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3979
3980 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3981 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3982 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3983 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3984 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3985 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3986 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3987 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3988
3989 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3990 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3991 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3992 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3993 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3994 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3995
3996 Example :
3997 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3998 frontend www
3999 mode http
4000 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4001
4002 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4003
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004005option abortonclose
4006no option abortonclose
4007 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4009 yes | no | yes | yes
4010 Arguments : none
4011
4012 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4013 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4014 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4015 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004016 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004017 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4018 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4019 encountered while delivering the response.
4020
4021 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4022 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4023 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4024 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4025 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4026 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004027 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004028 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004029 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004030 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4031 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4032 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4033
4034 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4035 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4036 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4037 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4038 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4039 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4040 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4041 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004042 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
4047 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4048
4049
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004050option accept-invalid-http-request
4051no option accept-invalid-http-request
4052 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4054 yes | yes | yes | no
4055 Arguments : none
4056
4057 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4058 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4059 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4060 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4061 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4062 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4063 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4064 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004065 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4066 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4067 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4068 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4069 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
4070 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004071
4072 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4073 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4074 been confirmed.
4075
4076 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4077 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004078 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4079 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004080 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4081
4082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4084
4085 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4086 stats socket.
4087
4088
4089option accept-invalid-http-response
4090no option accept-invalid-http-response
4091 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4093 yes | no | yes | yes
4094 Arguments : none
4095
4096 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
4097 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4098 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4099 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4100 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4101 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4102 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4103 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
4104 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
4105
4106 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4107 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4108 been confirmed.
4109
4110 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4111 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4112 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4113 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4114
4115 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4116 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4117
4118 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4119 stats socket.
4120
4121
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004122option allbackups
4123no option allbackups
4124 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | no | yes | yes
4127 Arguments : none
4128
4129 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4130 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4131 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4132 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4133 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4134 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4135 order between the backup servers anymore.
4136
4137 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4138 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4139
4140 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4141 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4142
4143
4144option checkcache
4145no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004146 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4148 yes | no | yes | yes
4149 Arguments : none
4150
4151 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4152 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004153 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004154 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4155 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004156 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004157
4158 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004159 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004160 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004161 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4162 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004163 to the client are :
4164 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004165 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004166 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004167 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4168 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4169 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4170 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4171 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4172 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4173 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4174 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4175 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4176 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4177 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4178
4179 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004180 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004181 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004182 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004183 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4184
4185 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4186 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004187 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004188 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4189
4190 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4191 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4192
4193
4194option clitcpka
4195no option clitcpka
4196 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 yes | yes | yes | no
4199 Arguments : none
4200
4201 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4202 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4203 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4204 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4205
4206 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4207 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4208 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4209 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4210
4211 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4212 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4213 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4214 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4215 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4216
4217 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4218
4219 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4220 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4221 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4222
4223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4225
4226 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4227
4228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229option contstats
4230 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4232 yes | yes | yes | no
4233 Arguments : none
4234
4235 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4236 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4237 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4238 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4239 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4240 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4241 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4242
4243
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004244option dontlog-normal
4245no option dontlog-normal
4246 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | yes | yes | no
4249 Arguments : none
4250
4251 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4252 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4253 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4254 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4255 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4256 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4257 logged.
4258
4259 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4260 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4261 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004263 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004264 logging.
4265
4266
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004267option dontlognull
4268no option dontlognull
4269 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 yes | yes | yes | no
4272 Arguments : none
4273
4274 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4275 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4276 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4277 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4278 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4279 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4280 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4281
4282 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4283 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4284 would not be logged.
4285
4286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004289 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004290
4291
4292option forceclose
4293no option forceclose
4294 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004296 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004297 Arguments : none
4298
4299 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4300 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4301 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4302 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4303 global session times in the logs.
4304
4305 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004306 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004307 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004308
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004309 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4310 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4311 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4312
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004313 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4314 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004315
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4318
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004319 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004320
4321
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004322option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004323 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4325 yes | yes | yes | yes
4326 Arguments :
4327 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4328 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004329 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004330 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004331
4332 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4333 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4334 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4335 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4336 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4337 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4338 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004339 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4340 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4341 possible that the client has already brought one.
4342
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004343 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004344 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004345 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4346 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004347 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4348 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004349
4350 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4351 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4352 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4353 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4354 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4355 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4356 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4357
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004358 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4359 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4360 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4361 are under the control of the end-user.
4362
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004363 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004364 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4365 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004366 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4367 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4368 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004369
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004370 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004371 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4372 frontend www
4373 mode http
4374 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4375
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004376 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4377 backend www
4378 mode http
4379 option forwardfor header X-Client
4380
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004381 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004382 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004383
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004384
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004385option http-keep-alive
4386no option http-keep-alive
4387 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | yes | yes | yes
4390 Arguments : none
4391
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004392 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4393 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4394 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4395 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4396 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4397 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4398 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4399
4400 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4401 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004402 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4403 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4404 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4405 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4406 situations where this option may be useful :
4407
4408 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4409 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4410
4411 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4412 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4413
4414 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4415 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4416 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4417 request.
4418
4419 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4420 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004421 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4422 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4423 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004424
4425 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4426 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4427
4428 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4429 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4430 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4431 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4432 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4433 not set.
4434
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004435 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4436 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004437 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004438 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004439
4440 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004441 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4442 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004443
4444
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004445option http-no-delay
4446no option http-no-delay
4447 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | yes | yes | yes
4450 Arguments : none
4451
4452 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4453 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4454 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4455 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4456 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4457 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4458 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4459 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4460 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4461 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4462 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4463 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4464 affected.
4465
4466 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4467 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4468 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4469 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4470 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4471 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4472 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4473 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4474 latency environments.
4475
4476
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004477option http-pretend-keepalive
4478no option http-pretend-keepalive
4479 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4481 yes | yes | yes | yes
4482 Arguments : none
4483
4484 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4485 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4486 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4487 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4488 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4489 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4490 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4491 consider the response complete.
4492
4493 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4494 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4495 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4496 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4497 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4498 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4499
4500 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4501 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4502 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4503 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4504 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4505 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4506 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4507
4508 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4509 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004510 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004511 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4512 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004513
4514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4516
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004517 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4518 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004519
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004520
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004521option http-server-close
4522no option http-server-close
4523 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4525 yes | yes | yes | yes
4526 Arguments : none
4527
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004528 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4529 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4530 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4531 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4532 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4533 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4534 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4535 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4536 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4537 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4538 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4539 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4540 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4541 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4542 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4543 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004544
4545 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4546 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4547 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4548 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004549 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4550 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004551
4552 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4553 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004554 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4555 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004556 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4557 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004558
4559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4561
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004562 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004563 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4564 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004565
4566
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004567option http-tunnel
4568no option http-tunnel
4569 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 yes | yes | yes | yes
4572 Arguments : none
4573
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004574 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4575 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4576 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4577 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4578 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4579 "option http-tunnel".
4580
4581 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004582 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004583 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4584 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4585 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4586 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4587 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4588 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4589 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004590
4591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4593
4594 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4595 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4596 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4597
4598
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004599option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004600no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004601 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4603 yes | yes | yes | no
4604 Arguments : none
4605
4606 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4607 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4608 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4609 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4610 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4611 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4612 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4613
4614 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4615 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4616 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4617 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4618 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4619 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4620 request along its whole life.
4621
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004622 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4623 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4624 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4625 front of an existing proxy.
4626
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004627 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4628
4629 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4630 http-server-close".
4631
4632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004633option httpchk
4634option httpchk <uri>
4635option httpchk <method> <uri>
4636option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4637 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4639 yes | no | yes | yes
4640 Arguments :
4641 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4642 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4643 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4644 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4645 ones.
4646
4647 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4648 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4649 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4650
4651 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4652 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4653 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4654 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4655 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4656
4657 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4658 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4659 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4660 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4661 the lack of any response.
4662
4663 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4664
4665 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4666 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4667 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4668
4669 Examples :
4670 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4671 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4672 backend https_relay
4673 mode tcp
4674 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4675 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4676
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004677 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4678 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4679 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004680
4681
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004682option httpclose
4683no option httpclose
4684 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4686 yes | yes | yes | yes
4687 Arguments : none
4688
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004689 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4690 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4691 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4692 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004693 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004694 "option http-tunnel".
4695
4696 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4697 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4698 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4699 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4700 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4701 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4702 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4703 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004704
4705 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004706 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004707 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4708 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4709 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4710 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4711 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004712
4713 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4714 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004715 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4716 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004717 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4718 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004719
4720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4722
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004723 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4724 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004725
4726
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004727option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004728 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004731 Arguments :
4732 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4733 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4734 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4735 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4736 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004737
4738 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4739 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4740 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4741 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4742 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4743 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4744 ports.
4745
4746 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4747
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004748 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4749 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004751 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004752
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004753
4754option http_proxy
4755no option http_proxy
4756 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | yes
4759 Arguments : none
4760
4761 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4762 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4763 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4764 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4765 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4766
4767 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4768 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4769 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4770 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004771 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004772 be analyzed.
4773
4774 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4775 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4776
4777 Example :
4778 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4779 backend direct_forward
4780 option httpclose
4781 option http_proxy
4782
4783 See also : "option httpclose"
4784
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004785
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004786option independent-streams
4787no option independent-streams
4788 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | yes | yes | yes
4791 Arguments : none
4792
4793 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4794 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4795 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4796 receive data or not.
4797
4798 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4799 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4800 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4801 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4802 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4803 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4804 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4805 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4806 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4807 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4808 socket buffers.
4809
4810 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4811 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4812 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4813 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4814 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4815
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004816 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004817 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4818 deprecated.
4819
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004820 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004821
4822
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004823option ldap-check
4824 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4826 yes | no | yes | yes
4827 Arguments : none
4828
4829 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4830 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4831 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4832 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4833
4834 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4835 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4836
4837 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4838 configure it.
4839
4840 Example :
4841 option ldap-check
4842
4843 See also : "option httpchk"
4844
4845
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004846option external-check
4847 Use external processes for server health checks
4848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850
4851 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4852 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4853 command".
4854
4855 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4856
4857 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4858
4859
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004860option log-health-checks
4861no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004862 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | no | yes | yes
4865 Arguments : none
4866
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004867 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4868 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4869 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004870
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004871 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4872 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4873 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4874 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4875 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4876
4877 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4878 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004879
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004880 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4881 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4882 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004883
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004884
4885option log-separate-errors
4886no option log-separate-errors
4887 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4889 yes | yes | yes | no
4890 Arguments : none
4891
4892 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4893 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4894 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4895 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4896 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4897 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4898 provides very important information.
4899
4900 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4901 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4902 error logs.
4903
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004904 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004905 logging.
4906
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004907
4908option logasap
4909no option logasap
4910 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4912 yes | yes | yes | no
4913 Arguments : none
4914
4915 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4916 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4917 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4918 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4919 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4920 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4921 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004922 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004923 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4924 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4925
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004926 Examples :
4927 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4928 mode http
4929 option httplog
4930 option logasap
4931 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4932
4933 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4934 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4935 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4936 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004938 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004939 logging.
4940
4941
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004942option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004943 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004946 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004947 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4948 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004949 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004950
4951 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4952 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4953 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4954 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4955 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4956 in the MySQL table, like this :
4957
4958 USE mysql;
4959 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4960 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4961
4962 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4963 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4964 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4965 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4966 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4967 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4968 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4969 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4970 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4971
4972 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4973 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004974
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004975 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004976
4977 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4978 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4979 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4980 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4981 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4982 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4983
4984 See also: "option httpchk"
4985
4986
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004987option nolinger
4988no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004989 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004992 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004993
4994 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4995 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4996 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4997 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4998 connections.
4999
5000 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5001 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5002 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5003 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5004 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5005 this too.
5006
5007 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5008 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5009 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5010
5011 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5012 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5013 for servers.
5014
5015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5017
5018
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005019option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5020 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 yes | yes | yes | yes
5023 Arguments :
5024 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5025 matching <network>
5026 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5027 header name.
5028
5029 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5030 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5031 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5032 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5033 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5034 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5035 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5036 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5037 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5038 possible that the client has already brought one.
5039
5040 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5041 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5042 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5043 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5044 header and requires different one.
5045
5046 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5047 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5048 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5049 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5050 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5051 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5052 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5053
5054 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5055 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5056 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5057 both are defined.
5058
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005059 Examples :
5060 # Original Destination address
5061 frontend www
5062 mode http
5063 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5064
5065 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5066 backend www
5067 mode http
5068 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5069
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005070 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5071 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005072
5073
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005074option persist
5075no option persist
5076 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005079 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005080
5081 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5082 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5083 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5084 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5085 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5086 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5087 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5088 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5089 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5090 redirected to another valid server.
5091
5092 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5093 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5094
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005095 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005096
5097
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005098option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5099 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | no | yes | yes
5102 Arguments :
5103 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5104 PostgreSQL server.
5105
5106 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5107 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5108 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5109 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5110
5111 See also: "option httpchk"
5112
5113
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005114option prefer-last-server
5115no option prefer-last-server
5116 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | no | yes | yes
5119 Arguments : none
5120
5121 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5122 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5123 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5124 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5125 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5126 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5127 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5128 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5129 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005130 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5131 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5132 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5133 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5134 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5135 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5136 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005137
5138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5140
5141 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5142
5143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005144option redispatch
5145no option redispatch
5146 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005149 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005150
5151 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5152 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5153 be able to access the service anymore.
5154
5155 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5156 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5157
5158 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5159 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5160 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005162 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5163 "redisp" keywords.
5164
5165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5167
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005168 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005169
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005170
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02005171option redis-check
5172 Use redis health checks for server testing
5173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5174 yes | no | yes | yes
5175 Arguments : none
5176
5177 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
5178 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
5179 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
5180 find the "+PONG" response message.
5181
5182 Example :
5183 option redis-check
5184
5185 See also : "option httpchk"
5186
5187
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005188option smtpchk
5189option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
5190 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005193 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005194 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
5195 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
5196 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
5197
5198 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
5199 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
5200 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
5201
5202 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
5203 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
5204 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
5205 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
5206 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
5207 dead server.
5208
5209 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
5210 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
5211 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
5212 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
5213
5214 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5215 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5216 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5217 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5218 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5219
5220 Example :
5221 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5222
5223 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005226option socket-stats
5227no option socket-stats
5228
5229 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5231 yes | yes | yes | no
5232
5233 Arguments : none
5234
5235
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005236option splice-auto
5237no option splice-auto
5238 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | yes | yes | yes
5241 Arguments : none
5242
5243 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5244 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5245 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5246 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005247 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005248 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5249 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5250 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5251 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5252
5253 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5254 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5255 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5256 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5257 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5258 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5259 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5260 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5261 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5262 keyword.
5263
5264 Example :
5265 option splice-auto
5266
5267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5269
5270 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5271 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5272
5273
5274option splice-request
5275no option splice-request
5276 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5278 yes | yes | yes | yes
5279 Arguments : none
5280
5281 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005282 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005283 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5284 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5285 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5286 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5287
5288 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5289
5290 Example :
5291 option splice-request
5292
5293 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5294 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5295
5296 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5297 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5298
5299
5300option splice-response
5301no option splice-response
5302 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
5307 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005308 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005309 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5310 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5311 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5312 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5313
5314 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5315
5316 Example :
5317 option splice-response
5318
5319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5321
5322 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5323 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5324
5325
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005326option srvtcpka
5327no option srvtcpka
5328 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5330 yes | no | yes | yes
5331 Arguments : none
5332
5333 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5334 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5335 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5336 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5337
5338 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5339 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5340 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5341 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5342
5343 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5344 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5345 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5346 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5347 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5348
5349 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5350
5351 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5352 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5353 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5354
5355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5357
5358 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5359
5360
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005361option ssl-hello-chk
5362 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | no | yes | yes
5365 Arguments : none
5366
5367 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5368 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5369 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5370 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5371 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5372 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5373 hello message.
5374
5375 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5376 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5377 messages, which is appreciable.
5378
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005379 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5380 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5381 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005382
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005383 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5384
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005385
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005386option tcp-check
5387 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5388 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 yes | no | yes | yes
5390
5391 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5392 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5393
5394 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5395 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5396 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5397
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005398 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005399 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5400 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5401 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5402 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5403 only.
5404
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005405 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005406 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5407 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5408 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5409 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5410
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005411 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005412 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5413 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005414 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005415 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5416 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5417 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5418 the respective protocols.
5419 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5420 analysed.
5421
5422 Examples :
5423 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5424 option tcp-check
5425 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5426
5427 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5428 option tcp-check
5429 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5430
5431 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5432 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005433 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005434 option tcp-check
5435 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5436 tcp-check expect +PONG
5437 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5438 tcp-check expect string role:master
5439 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5440 tcp-check expect string +OK
5441
5442 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5443 (send many headers before analyzing)
5444 option tcp-check
5445 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5446 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5447 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5448 tcp-check send \r\n
5449 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5450
5451
5452 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5453
5454
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005455option tcp-smart-accept
5456no option tcp-smart-accept
5457 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | yes | yes | no
5460 Arguments : none
5461
5462 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5463 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5464 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5465 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5466 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5467 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5468
5469 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5470 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5471 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5472 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5473
5474 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5475 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5476 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5477 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5478
5479 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5480 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5481 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5482
5483 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5484 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5485 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5486
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005487 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5488
5489
5490option tcp-smart-connect
5491no option tcp-smart-connect
5492 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | no | yes | yes
5495 Arguments : none
5496
5497 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5498 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5499 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5500 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5501 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5502
5503 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5504 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5505 complex.
5506
5507 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5508 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5509 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5510
5511 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5512 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5513
5514 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5515
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005516
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005517option tcpka
5518 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | yes | yes | yes
5521 Arguments : none
5522
5523 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5524 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5525 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5526 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5527
5528 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5529 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5530 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5531 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5532
5533 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5534 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5535 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5536 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5537 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5538
5539 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5540
5541 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5542 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5543 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5544 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5545 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5546 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5547 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5548 backends.
5549
5550 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5551
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005552
5553option tcplog
5554 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5556 yes | yes | yes | yes
5557 Arguments : none
5558
5559 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5560 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5561 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5562 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5563 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5564 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5565 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5566 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5567
5568 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005570 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005571
5572
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005573option transparent
5574no option transparent
5575 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005577 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005578 Arguments : none
5579
5580 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5581 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5582 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5583 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5584 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5585 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5586 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5587 appropriate server.
5588
5589 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5590 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5591
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005592 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005593 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005594
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005595
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005596external-check command <command>
5597 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5599 yes | no | yes | yes
5600
5601 Arguments :
5602 <command> is the external command to run
5603
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005604 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5605
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005606 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005607
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005608 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5609 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5610 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5611 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5612 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5613 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005614
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005615 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5616
5617 Environment variables :
5618 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5619 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5620
5621 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5622
5623 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5624
5625 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5626 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5627 for a UNIX socket).
5628
5629 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5630
5631 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5632
5633 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5634
5635 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5636
5637 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5638
5639 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5640 socket).
5641
5642 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5643 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5644
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005645 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5646 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5647 failed.
5648
5649 Example :
5650 external-check command /bin/true
5651
5652 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5653
5654
5655external-check path <path>
5656 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
5659
5660 Arguments :
5661 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5662
5663 The default path is "".
5664
5665 Example :
5666 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5667
5668 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5669 "external-check command"
5670
5671
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005672persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005673persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005674 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 yes | no | yes | yes
5677 Arguments :
5678 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005679 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5680 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005681
5682 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5683 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5684 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5685 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5686 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5687 forwarded to this server.
5688
5689 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5690 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5691 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005692 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005693 a single "listen" section.
5694
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005695 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5696 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5697 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5698
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005699 Example :
5700 listen tse-farm
5701 bind :3389
5702 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5703 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5704 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5705 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5706 persist rdp-cookie
5707 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005708 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005709 balance rdp-cookie
5710 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5711 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5712
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005713 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5714 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005715
5716
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005717rate-limit sessions <rate>
5718 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5720 yes | yes | yes | no
5721 Arguments :
5722 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5723 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5724
5725 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5726 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5727 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5728 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5729 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5730 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5731
5732 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5733 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5734 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5735 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5736
5737 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5738 listen smtp
5739 mode tcp
5740 bind :25
5741 rate-limit sessions 10
5742 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5743
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005744 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5745 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5746 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005747
5748 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5749
5750
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005751redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5752redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5753redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005754 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 no | yes | yes | yes
5757
5758 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005759 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005760
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005761 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005762 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005763 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5764 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5765 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005766
5767 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5768 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5769 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5770 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5771 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005772 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5773 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5774 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5775 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005776
5777 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5778 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5779 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5780 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5781 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5782 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005783 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005784 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005785 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5786 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5787 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005788
5789 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005790 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5791 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5792 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5793 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5794 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5795 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5796 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5797 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005798
5799 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5800 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5801
5802 - "drop-query"
5803 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5804 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5805 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5806 with a location-type redirect.
5807
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005808 - "append-slash"
5809 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5810 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5811 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5812 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5813
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005814 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5815 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5816 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5817 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5818 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5819 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5820 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5821
5822 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5823 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5824 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5825 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5826 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5827 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5828 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005829
5830 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5831 acl clear dst_port 80
5832 acl secure dst_port 8080
5833 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005834 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005835 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005836 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5837
5838 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005839 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5840 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5841 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005842 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005843
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005844 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5845 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5846 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5847
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005848 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005849 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005850
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005851 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5852 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5853 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005855 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005856
5857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005858redisp (deprecated)
5859redispatch (deprecated)
5860 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005863 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005864
5865 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5866 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5867 be able to access the service anymore.
5868
5869 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5870 redistribute them to a working server.
5871
5872 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5873 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5874 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005875
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005876 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5877 "option redispatch" instead.
5878
5879 See also : "option redispatch"
5880
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005881
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005882reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005883 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5885 no | yes | yes | yes
5886 Arguments :
5887 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5888 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005889 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005890
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005891 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5892 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5893
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005894 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5895 the last header of an HTTP request.
5896
5897 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5898 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5899 responses.
5900
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005901 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5902 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5903 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5904
5905 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5906 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005907
5908
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005909reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5910reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005911 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5913 no | yes | yes | yes
5914 Arguments :
5915 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5916 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5917 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5918 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5919 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5920 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5921 ignores case.
5922
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005923 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5924 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5925
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005926 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5927 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5928 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5929 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005930 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005931
5932 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5933 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5934
5935 Example :
5936 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5937 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5938 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5939
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005940 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5941 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005942
5943
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005944reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5945reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005946 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5948 no | yes | yes | yes
5949 Arguments :
5950 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5951 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5952 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5953 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5954 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5955 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5956
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005957 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5958 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5959
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005960 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5961 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5962 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5963 next servers.
5964
5965 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5966 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5967 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5968
5969 Example :
5970 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5971 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5972 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5973
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005974 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5975 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005976
5977
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005978reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5979reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005980 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5982 no | yes | yes | yes
5983 Arguments :
5984 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5985 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5986 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5987 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5988 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5989 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5990 case.
5991
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005992 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5993 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5994
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005995 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5996 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5997 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5998 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005999 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006000
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006001 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006002 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006003 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006004
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006005 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6006 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6007
6008 Example :
6009 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6010 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6011 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6012
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006013 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6014 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006015
6016
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006017reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6018reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006019 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6021 no | yes | yes | yes
6022 Arguments :
6023 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6024 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6025 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6026 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6027 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6028 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6029 case.
6030
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006031 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6032 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6033
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006034 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6035 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6036 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6037 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6038
6039 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6040 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6041
6042 Example :
6043 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6044 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6045 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6046 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6047
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006048 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
6049 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006050
6051
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006052reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6053reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006054 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6056 no | yes | yes | yes
6057 Arguments :
6058 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6059 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6060 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6061 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6062 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6063 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6064
6065 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6066 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6067 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6068 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006069 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006070
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006071 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6072 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6073
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006074 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6075 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6076 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6077
6078 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6079 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6080 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6081 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6082 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6083
6084 Example :
6085 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006086 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006087 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6088 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6089
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04006090 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
6091 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006092
6093
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006094reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6095reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006096 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 no | yes | yes | yes
6099 Arguments :
6100 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6101 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6102 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6103 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6104 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6105 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6106 ignores case.
6107
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006108 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6109 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6110
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006111 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6112 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006113 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6114 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6115 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006116 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6117 not set.
6118
6119 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6120 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6121 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6122 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6123 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6124
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006125 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006126 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6127 # block all others.
6128 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6129 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6130
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006131 # block bad guys
6132 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6133 reqitarpit . if badguys
6134
6135 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
6136 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006137
6138
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006139retries <value>
6140 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6142 yes | no | yes | yes
6143 Arguments :
6144 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6145 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6146 default value is 3.
6147
6148 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6149 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6150 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6151
6152 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
6153 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
6154
6155 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
6156 server even if a cookie references a different server.
6157
6158 See also : "option redispatch"
6159
6160
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006161rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006162 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
6163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 no | yes | yes | yes
6165 Arguments :
6166 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6167 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006168 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006169
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006170 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6171 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6172
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006173 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6174 the last header of an HTTP response.
6175
6176 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6177 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6178 responses.
6179
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006180 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
6181 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006182
6183
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006184rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6185rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006186 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6188 no | yes | yes | yes
6189 Arguments :
6190 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6191 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6192 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6193 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6194 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6195 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
6196 ignores case.
6197
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006198 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6199 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006201 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
6202 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006203 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006204 client.
6205
6206 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6207 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6208 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6209
6210 Example :
6211 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02006212 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006213
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006214 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6215 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006216
6217
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006218rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6219rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006220 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6222 no | yes | yes | yes
6223 Arguments :
6224 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6225 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6226 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6227 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6228 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6229 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6230 ignores case.
6231
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006232 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6233 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6234
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006235 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6236 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6237 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6238 case-sensitive.
6239
6240 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006241 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6242 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6243 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006244
6245 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6246 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6247
6248 Example :
6249 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6250 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6251
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006252 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6253 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006254
6255
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006256rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6257rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006258 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6260 no | yes | yes | yes
6261 Arguments :
6262 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6263 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6264 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6265 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6266 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6267 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6268 ignores case.
6269
6270 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6271 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6272 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6273 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006274 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006275
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006276 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6277 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6278
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006279 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6280 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6281 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6282
6283 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6284 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6285 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6286 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6287 are not case-sensitive.
6288
6289 Example :
6290 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6291 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6292
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006293 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6294 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006295
6296
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006297server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006298 Declare a server in a backend
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6300 no | no | yes | yes
6301 Arguments :
6302 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006303 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006304 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006305
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006306 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6307 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6308 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6309 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006310 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6311 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6312 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6313 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6314 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006315 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6316 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6317 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6318 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6319 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6320 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6321 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006322 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006323 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6324 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6325 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6326 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006327
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006328 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006329 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6330 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6331 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6332 adding this value to the client's port.
6333
6334 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6335 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006336 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006337
6338 Examples :
6339 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6340 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006341 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006342 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6343 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6344 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006345
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006346 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6347 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006348
6349
6350source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006351source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006352source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006353 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | no | yes | yes
6356 Arguments :
6357 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6358 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006359
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006360 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006361 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6362 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6363 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6364 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6365 supported prefixes are :
6366 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6367 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6368 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006369 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006370 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6371 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6372 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6373 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006374
6375 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6376 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006377 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6378 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6379 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006380
6381 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6382 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6383 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6384 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6385 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6386 <addr>.
6387
6388 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6389 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6390 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6391 port.
6392
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006393 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6394 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6395 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6396 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006397 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006398 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6399 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6400 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6401 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6402 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6403 HTTP header.
6404
6405 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6406 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006407 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006408 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6409 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6410 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6411 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6412 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6413 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6414 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6415
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006416 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6417 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6418 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6419 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6420 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6421 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6422
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006423 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6424 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6425 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6426 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6427
6428 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6429 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6430 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6431 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6432 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6433 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6434
6435 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6436 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6437 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6438 there are two methods :
6439
6440 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6441 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6442 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6443 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6444 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6445 of the client ranges may be used.
6446
6447 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6448 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6449 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6450 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6451 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6452 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6453 same session.
6454
6455 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6456 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6457 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6458 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6459 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6460 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6461
6462 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6463 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6464 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006465 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006466
6467 Examples :
6468 backend private
6469 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6470 source 192.168.1.200
6471
6472 backend transparent_ssl1
6473 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6474 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6475
6476 backend transparent_ssl2
6477 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6478 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6479 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6480
6481 backend transparent_ssl3
6482 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6483 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6484 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6485
6486 backend transparent_smtp
6487 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6488 # with Tproxy version 4.
6489 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6490
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006491 backend transparent_http
6492 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6493 # proxy.
6494 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006496 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006497 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6498
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006499
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006500srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6501 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6503 yes | no | yes | yes
6504 Arguments :
6505 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6506 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6507 as explained at the top of this document.
6508
6509 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6510 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6511 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6512 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6513 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6514 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6515 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6516
6517 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6518 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6519 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6520 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6521 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006522 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006523 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006524 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006525
6526 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6527 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6528 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6529 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6530 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6531 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6532
6533 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6534 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6535
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006536 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6537 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006538
6539
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006540stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6541 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006543 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006544
6545 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6546 matched.
6547
6548 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6549 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6550
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006551 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6552 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6553 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6554
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006555 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6556 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6557 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6558 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006559
6560 Example :
6561 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6562 backend stats_localhost
6563 stats enable
6564 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6565
6566 Example :
6567 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6568 backend stats_auth
6569 stats enable
6570 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6571 stats admin if TRUE
6572
6573 Example :
6574 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6575 userlist stats-auth
6576 group admin users admin
6577 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6578 group readonly users haproxy
6579 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6580
6581 backend stats_auth
6582 stats enable
6583 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6584 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6585 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6586 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6587
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006588 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6589 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6590 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006591
6592
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006593stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6594 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006596 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006597 Arguments :
6598 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6599
6600 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6601
6602 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6603 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6604 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6605 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6606 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6607 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6608
6609 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6610 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6611 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006612 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006613
6614 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6615 report using "stats scope".
6616
6617 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6618 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6619 unobvious parameters.
6620
6621 Example :
6622 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6623 backend public_www
6624 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6625 stats enable
6626 stats hide-version
6627 stats scope .
6628 stats uri /admin?stats
6629 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6630 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6631 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6632
6633 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6634 backend private_monitoring
6635 stats enable
6636 stats uri /admin?stats
6637 stats refresh 5s
6638
6639 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6640
6641
6642stats enable
6643 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006645 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006646 Arguments : none
6647
6648 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6649 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6650 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6651 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6652 - stats auth : no authentication
6653 - stats scope : no restriction
6654
6655 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6656 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6657 unobvious parameters.
6658
6659 Example :
6660 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6661 backend public_www
6662 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6663 stats enable
6664 stats hide-version
6665 stats scope .
6666 stats uri /admin?stats
6667 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6668 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6669 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6670
6671 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6672 backend private_monitoring
6673 stats enable
6674 stats uri /admin?stats
6675 stats refresh 5s
6676
6677 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6678
6679
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006680stats hide-version
6681 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006683 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006684 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006686 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6687 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6688 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6689 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6690 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6691 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006692
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006693 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6694 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6695 unobvious parameters.
6696
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006697 Example :
6698 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6699 backend public_www
6700 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006701 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006702 stats hide-version
6703 stats scope .
6704 stats uri /admin?stats
6705 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6706 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6707 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006708
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006709 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6710 backend private_monitoring
6711 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006712 stats uri /admin?stats
6713 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006714
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006715 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006716
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006717
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006718stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6719 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6720 Access control for statistics
6721
6722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6723 no | no | yes | yes
6724
6725 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6726 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6727 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6728 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6729 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6730 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6731
6732 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6733 instance.
6734
6735 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6736 about ACL usage.
6737
6738
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006739stats realm <realm>
6740 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006743 Arguments :
6744 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6745 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6746 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6747
6748 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6749 using a backslash ('\').
6750
6751 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6752 only related to authentication.
6753
6754 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6755 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6756 unobvious parameters.
6757
6758 Example :
6759 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6760 backend public_www
6761 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6762 stats enable
6763 stats hide-version
6764 stats scope .
6765 stats uri /admin?stats
6766 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6767 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6768 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6769
6770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6771 backend private_monitoring
6772 stats enable
6773 stats uri /admin?stats
6774 stats refresh 5s
6775
6776 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6777
6778
6779stats refresh <delay>
6780 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006782 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006783 Arguments :
6784 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6785 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6786 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6787 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6788 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6789 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6790
6791 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6792 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6793 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6794 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6795
6796 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6797 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6798 unobvious parameters.
6799
6800 Example :
6801 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6802 backend public_www
6803 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6804 stats enable
6805 stats hide-version
6806 stats scope .
6807 stats uri /admin?stats
6808 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6809 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6810 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6811
6812 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6813 backend private_monitoring
6814 stats enable
6815 stats uri /admin?stats
6816 stats refresh 5s
6817
6818 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6819
6820
6821stats scope { <name> | "." }
6822 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006824 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006825 Arguments :
6826 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6827 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6828 section in which the statement appears.
6829
6830 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6831 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6832 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6833 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6834 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6835 exists.
6836
6837 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6838 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6839 unobvious parameters.
6840
6841 Example :
6842 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6843 backend public_www
6844 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6845 stats enable
6846 stats hide-version
6847 stats scope .
6848 stats uri /admin?stats
6849 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6850 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6851 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6852
6853 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6854 backend private_monitoring
6855 stats enable
6856 stats uri /admin?stats
6857 stats refresh 5s
6858
6859 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6860
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006861
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006862stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006863 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006865 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006866
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006867 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006868 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6869
6870 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6871 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6872
6873 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6874 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006875 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006876
6877 Example :
6878 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6879 backend private_monitoring
6880 stats enable
6881 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6882 stats uri /admin?stats
6883 stats refresh 5s
6884
6885 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6886 global section.
6887
6888
6889stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006890 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6892 yes | yes | yes | yes
6893 Arguments : none
6894
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006895 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006896 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6897 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6898 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6899 - IP (socket, server)
6900 - cookie (backend, server)
6901
6902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006904 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006905
6906 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6907
6908
6909stats show-node [ <name> ]
6910 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006912 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006913 Arguments:
6914 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6915 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6916
6917 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6918 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006919 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006920
6921 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6922 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6923 unobvious parameters.
6924
6925 Example:
6926 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6927 backend private_monitoring
6928 stats enable
6929 stats show-node Europe-1
6930 stats uri /admin?stats
6931 stats refresh 5s
6932
6933 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6934 section.
6935
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006936
6937stats uri <prefix>
6938 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006940 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006941 Arguments :
6942 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6943 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6944 query string.
6945
6946 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6947 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6948 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6949 possible to reach it in the application.
6950
6951 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006952 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006953 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6954 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6955 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6956 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6957
6958 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6959 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6960 an address or a port to statistics only.
6961
6962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6964 unobvious parameters.
6965
6966 Example :
6967 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6968 backend public_www
6969 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6970 stats enable
6971 stats hide-version
6972 stats scope .
6973 stats uri /admin?stats
6974 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6975 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6976 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6977
6978 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6979 backend private_monitoring
6980 stats enable
6981 stats uri /admin?stats
6982 stats refresh 5s
6983
6984 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6985
6986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006987stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6988 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006990 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006991
6992 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006993 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006994 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6995 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6996 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6997
6998 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6999 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7000 the "stick-table" statement.
7001
7002 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7003 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7004 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7005 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7006 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7007
7008 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7009 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7010 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7011 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7012 transformation rules.
7013
7014 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7015 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7016 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7017 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7018 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7019 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7020 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7021
7022 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7023 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7024 ACL based conditions.
7025
7026 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7027 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7028 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7029 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7030
7031 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7032 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7033 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7034 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7035
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007036 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7037 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7038 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7039
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007040 Example :
7041 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7042 # last 30 minutes
7043 backend pop
7044 mode tcp
7045 balance roundrobin
7046 stick store-request src
7047 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7048 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7049 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7050
7051 backend smtp
7052 mode tcp
7053 balance roundrobin
7054 stick match src table pop
7055 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7056 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7057
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007058 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007059 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007060
7061
7062stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7063 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7065 no | no | yes | yes
7066
7067 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7068 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7069 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7070 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7071
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007072 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7073 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7074 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7075
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007076 Examples :
7077 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007078 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007079
7080 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7081 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7082 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7083
7084
7085 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7086 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7087 backend http
7088 mode http
7089 balance roundrobin
7090 stick on src table https
7091 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7092 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7093 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7094
7095 backend https
7096 mode tcp
7097 balance roundrobin
7098 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7099 stick on src
7100 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7101 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7102
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007103 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007104
7105
7106stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7107 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | no | yes | yes
7110
7111 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007112 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007113 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7114 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7115 server is selected.
7116
7117 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7118 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7119 the "stick-table" statement.
7120
7121 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7122 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7123 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7124 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7125 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7126 address.
7127
7128 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7129 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7130 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7131 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7132 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7133 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7134 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7135 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7136 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7137 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
7138
7139 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7140 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7141 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7142 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7143 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7144 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7145 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7146
7147 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
7148 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7149 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
7150 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7151
7152 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
7153 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7154 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7155 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7156 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7157 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007158 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
7159 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7160 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7161 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7162 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7163 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007164
7165 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
7166 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
7167 the request.
7168
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007169 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7170 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7171 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7172
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007173 Example :
7174 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7175 # last 30 minutes
7176 backend pop
7177 mode tcp
7178 balance roundrobin
7179 stick store-request src
7180 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7181 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7182 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7183
7184 backend smtp
7185 mode tcp
7186 balance roundrobin
7187 stick match src table pop
7188 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7189 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7190
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007191 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007192 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007193
7194
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007195stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007196 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
7197 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08007198 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007200 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007201
7202 Arguments :
7203 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
7204 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
7205 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7206 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7207
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01007208 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
7209 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
7210 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
7211 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
7212
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007213 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7214 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7215 instance.
7216
7217 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7218 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7219 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7220 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7221 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7222 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007223 to 32 characters.
7224
7225 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7226 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7227 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007228 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007229 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7230 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007231
7232 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007233 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7234 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007235 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7236 increase.
7237
7238 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007239 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7240 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7241 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007242
7243 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7244 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7245 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7246 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7247 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7248 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7249 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7250 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7251 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7252 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7253 parameter (see below).
7254
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007255 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7256 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7257 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7258 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7259 soft restart.
7260
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007261 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7262
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007263 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7264 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7265 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7266 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7267 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007268 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007269 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7270 if not expiration delay is specified.
7271
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007272 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7273 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7274 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7275 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007276 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7277 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7278 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7279 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7280 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7281 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7282 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7283 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7284 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7285 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7286 types and their arguments.
7287
7288 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7289 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7290 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7291 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7292
7293 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7294 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7295 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7296 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7297
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007298 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7299 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7300 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7301 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7302 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7303 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7304
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007305 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7306 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7307 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7308 they were received.
7309
7310 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7311 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7312 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7313 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7314 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7315
7316 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7317 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7318 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7319 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7320 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7321
7322 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7323 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7324 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7325
7326 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7327 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7328 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7329 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7330 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7331
7332 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7333 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7334 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7335 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7336 the client side.
7337
7338 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7339 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7340 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7341 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7342 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7343 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7344 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7345
7346 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7347 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7348 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7349 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7350 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7351 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7352 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7353
7354 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7355 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7356 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7357 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7358 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7359 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7360
7361 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7362 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7363 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7364 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7365
7366 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7367 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7368 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7369 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7370 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7371 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7372 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7373 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7374 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7375 recommended for better fairness.
7376
7377 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7378 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7379 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7380 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7381
7382 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7383 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7384 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7385 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7386 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7387 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7388 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7389 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7390 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7391 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007392
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007393 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7394 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007395 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7396 reference it.
7397
7398 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7399 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7400 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7401 as an exclusive stickiness.
7402
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007403 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7404 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7405 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7406 something that can be ignored.
7407
7408 Example:
7409 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7410 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7411 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7412 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7413
7414 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007415 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007416
7417
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007418stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7419 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7421 no | no | yes | yes
7422
7423 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007424 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007425 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7426 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7427 server is selected.
7428
7429 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7430 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7431 the "stick-table" statement.
7432
7433 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7434 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7435 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7436 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7437
7438 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7439 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7440 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7441 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7442 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7443 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007444 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007445 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7446 rules.
7447
7448 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7449 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7450 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7451 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7452 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7453 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7454 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7455
7456 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7457 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7458 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7459 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7460
7461 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7462 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7463 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7464 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7465 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7466 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007467 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7468 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7469 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7470 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7471 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7472 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7473 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7474 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7475 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007476
7477 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7478
7479 Example :
7480 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7481 backend https
7482 mode tcp
7483 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007484 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007485 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007486
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007487 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7488 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7489
7490 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7491 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7492 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7493
7494 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7495 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007496
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007497 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7498 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7499 # at offset 44.
7500
7501 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7502 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7503
7504 # Learn on response if server hello.
7505 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007506
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007507 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7508 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7509
7510 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7511 extraction.
7512
7513
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007514tcp-check connect [params*]
7515 Opens a new connection
7516 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 no | no | yes | yes
7518
7519 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7520 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7521 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7522
7523 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7524 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7525 of the sequence.
7526
7527 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7528 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7529 do.
7530
7531 Parameters :
7532 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7533 use the TCP connection.
7534
7535 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7536 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7537 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7538
7539 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7540
7541 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7542
7543 Examples:
7544 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7545 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7546 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7547 option tcp-check
7548 tcp-check connect
7549 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7550 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7551 tcp-check send \r\n
7552 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7553 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7554 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7555 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7556 tcp-check send \r\n
7557 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7558 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7559
7560 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7561 option tcp-check
7562 tcp-check connect port 110
7563 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7564 tcp-check connect port 143
7565 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7566 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7567
7568 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7569
7570
7571tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7572 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7574 no | no | yes | yes
7575
7576 Arguments :
7577 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7578 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7579 binary.
7580 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7581 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7582 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7583
7584 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7585 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7586 with the usual backslash ('\').
7587 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7588 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7589 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7590 used upper or lower case.
7591
7592
7593 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7594
7595 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7596 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7597 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7598 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7599 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7600 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7601 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7602 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7603
7604 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7605 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7606 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7607 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7608 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7609 expression.
7610
7611 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7612 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7613 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7614 this exact hexadecimal string.
7615 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7616
7617 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7618 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7619 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7620 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7621 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7622 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7623 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7624 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7625 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7626 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7627 the null character.
7628
7629 Examples :
7630 # perform a POP check
7631 option tcp-check
7632 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7633
7634 # perform an IMAP check
7635 option tcp-check
7636 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7637
7638 # look for the redis master server
7639 option tcp-check
7640 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7641 tcp-check expect +PONG
7642 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7643 tcp-check expect string role:master
7644 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7645 tcp-check expect string +OK
7646
7647
7648 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7649 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7650
7651
7652tcp-check send <data>
7653 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7654 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7655 no | no | yes | yes
7656
7657 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7658 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7659
7660 Examples :
7661 # look for the redis master server
7662 option tcp-check
7663 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7664 tcp-check expect string role:master
7665
7666 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7667 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7668
7669
7670tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7671 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7672 tcp health check
7673 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 no | no | yes | yes
7675
7676 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7677 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7678 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7679 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7680 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7681 hexadecimal string.
7682 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7683
7684 Examples :
7685 # redis check in binary
7686 option tcp-check
7687 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7688 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7689
7690
7691 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7692 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7693
7694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007695tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7696 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7698 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007699 Arguments :
7700 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007701 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7702 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007703
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007704 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007705
7706 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7707 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007708 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7709 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7710 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7711 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7712 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7713 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007714
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007715 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7716 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7717 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7718 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007719
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007720 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007721 - accept :
7722 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7723 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7724 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007726 - reject :
7727 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7728 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7729 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7730 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7731 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7732 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7733 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7734 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7735 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7736 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7737 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7738 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007739
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007740 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7741 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7742 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7743 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7744 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7745 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7746 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7747 hosts.
7748
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007749 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7750 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7751 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7752 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7753 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7754 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7755 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7756 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7757 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7758 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7759 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7760
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007761 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007762 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007763 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007764 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007765 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7766 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007767 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007768 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7769 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7770 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7771 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7772 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007773
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007774 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007775 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007776 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007777 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7778 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7779 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7780 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007781
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007782 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7783 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7784 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7785 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007787 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7788 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7789 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7790 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7791 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007792 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7793 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7794 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7795 layer7 information is extracted.
7796
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007797 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7798 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7799 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7800 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7801 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007803 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7804 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7805 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007807 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7808 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7809 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007811 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007812 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007813 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007814
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007815 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7816 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7817 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007819 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007820 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7821 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007822
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007823 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7824
7825 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7826
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007827 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007829 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007830
7831
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007832tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7833 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007835 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007836 Arguments :
7837 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007838 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007839 "track-sc2", "capture" and "lua". See "tcp-request connection"
7840 above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007841
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007842 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007843
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007844 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7845 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7846 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7847 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7848 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007850 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7851 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7852 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7853 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007854 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7855 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7856 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7857 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7858 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7859 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007860 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007861 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007862
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007863 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7864 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7865 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7866 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007867
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007868 Four types of actions are supported :
7869 - accept : the request is accepted
7870 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7871 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007872 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007874 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7875 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007876
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007877 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7878 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7879 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7880 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7881 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7882 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007883
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007884 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007885 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7886 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007888 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007889 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7890 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7891 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7892 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007893 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7894 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7895 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007896
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007897 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007898 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7899 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7900 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007901
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01007902 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
7903 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
7904 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
7905 documentation.
7906
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007907 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007908 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7909 # and reject everything else.
7910 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7911 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007912 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007913 tcp-request content reject
7914
7915 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007916 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7917 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7918 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007919 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007920
7921 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7922 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7923 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007924 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007925 tcp-request content reject
7926
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007927 Example:
7928 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7929 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007930 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007931
7932 Example:
7933 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7934 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007935 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007937 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7938 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7939
7940 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007941 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007942 # protecting all our sites
7943 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007944 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7945 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007946 ...
7947 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7948
7949 backend http_dynamic
7950 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007951 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007952 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007953 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7954 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7955 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007956 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007958 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007960 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007961
7962
7963tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7964 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007966 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007967 Arguments :
7968 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7969 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7970 as explained at the top of this document.
7971
7972 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7973 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7974 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7975 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7976 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7977
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007978 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7979 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7980 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7981 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7982
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007983 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7984 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007985 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007986 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007987 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7988 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7989 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7990 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007991
7992 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7993 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7994 it pass through unaffected.
7995
7996 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7997 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7998 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007999 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008000 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8001 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008002 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8003 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8004 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008005
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008006 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008007 "timeout client".
8008
8009
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008010tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8011 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 no | no | yes | yes
8014 Arguments :
8015 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008016 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject", "lua".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008017
8018 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8019
8020 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8021 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8022 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008023 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8024 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008025
8026 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8027
8028 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8029 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8030 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8031 inserted.
8032
8033 Two types of actions are supported :
8034 - accept :
8035 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8036 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8037 the rules evaluation.
8038
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008039 - close :
8040 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8041 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8042 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8043 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8044 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8045 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008046 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008047 protocols.
8048
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008049 - reject :
8050 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8051 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008052 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008053
8054 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8055 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8056 for changing the default action to a reject.
8057
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008058 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
8059 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
8060 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
8061 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008062 period.
8063
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01008064 The "lua" keyword is followed by a Lua function name. It is used to run a Lua
8065 function if the action is executed. The single parameter is the name of the
8066 function to run. The prototype of the function is documented in the API
8067 documentation.
8068
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008069 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8070
8071 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
8072
8073
8074tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
8075 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8077 no | no | yes | yes
8078 Arguments :
8079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8081 as explained at the top of this document.
8082
8083 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
8084
8085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008086timeout check <timeout>
8087 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
8088 established.
8089
8090 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 yes | no | yes | yes
8092 Arguments:
8093 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8094 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8095 as explained at the top of this document.
8096
8097 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
8098 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
8099 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
8100 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01008101 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
8102 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
8103 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008104
8105 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
8106 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
8107
8108 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
8109 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008110 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008111
8112 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8113 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8114 forget about it.
8115
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008116 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
8117 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008118
8119
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008120timeout client <timeout>
8121timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8122 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
8123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8124 yes | yes | yes | no
8125 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008126 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008127 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8128 as explained at the top of this document.
8129
8130 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8131 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8132 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
8133 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
8134 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
8135 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
8136 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
8137 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008138 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008139 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008140 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
8141 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008142 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
8143 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008144
8145 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8146 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8147 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8148 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8149 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8150 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8151
8152 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
8153 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
8154 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8155
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008156 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008157
8158
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008159timeout client-fin <timeout>
8160 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8162 yes | yes | yes | no
8163 Arguments :
8164 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8165 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8166 as explained at the top of this document.
8167
8168 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
8169 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8170 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8171 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8172 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
8173 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8174 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8175 down in one direction.
8176
8177 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
8178 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8179 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
8180
8181 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
8182
8183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008184timeout connect <timeout>
8185timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8186 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
8187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8188 yes | no | yes | yes
8189 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008190 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008191 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8192 as explained at the top of this document.
8193
8194 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008195 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008196 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008197 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01008198 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
8199 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008200
8201 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8202 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8203 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8204 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8205 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
8206 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8207
8208 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
8209 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
8210 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8211
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01008212 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
8213 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008214
8215
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008216timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
8217 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8219 yes | yes | yes | yes
8220 Arguments :
8221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8223 as explained at the top of this document.
8224
8225 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8226 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8227 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8228 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8229 once the request has started to present itself.
8230
8231 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8232 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8233 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8234 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8235 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8236
8237 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8238 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8239 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8240 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8241
8242 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8243 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8244 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8245 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8246 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008247 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008248
8249 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8250 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8251 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8252 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8253
8254 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8255
8256
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008257timeout http-request <timeout>
8258 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008261 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008262 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008263 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8264 as explained at the top of this document.
8265
8266 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8267 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8268 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8269 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8270 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8271 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8272 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008273 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8274 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8275 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8276 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8277 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8278 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8279 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008280
8281 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8282 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008283 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8284 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008285
8286 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8287 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8288 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8289 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8290 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8291
8292 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008293 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8294 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8295 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008296
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008297 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008298
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008299
8300timeout queue <timeout>
8301 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8303 yes | no | yes | yes
8304 Arguments :
8305 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8306 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8307 as explained at the top of this document.
8308
8309 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8310 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8311 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8312 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8313 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8314
8315 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8316 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8317 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8318 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8319
8320 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8321
8322
8323timeout server <timeout>
8324timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8325 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8327 yes | no | yes | yes
8328 Arguments :
8329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8331 as explained at the top of this document.
8332
8333 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8334 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8335 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8336 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8337 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8338 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8339 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8340
8341 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8342 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8343 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8344 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8345 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008346 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008347 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008348 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8349 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8350 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8351 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008352
8353 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8354 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8355 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8356 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8357 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8358 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8359
8360 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8361 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8362 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8363
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008364 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008365
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008366
8367timeout server-fin <timeout>
8368 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8370 yes | no | yes | yes
8371 Arguments :
8372 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8373 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8374 as explained at the top of this document.
8375
8376 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8377 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8378 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8379 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8380 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8381 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8382 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8383 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8384 situations, it should not be needed.
8385
8386 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8387 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8388 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8389
8390 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8391
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008392
8393timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008394 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8396 yes | yes | yes | yes
8397 Arguments :
8398 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8400 as explained at the top of this document.
8401
8402 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8403 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8404 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8405
8406 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8407 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8408 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8409 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008410 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008411
8412 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8413
8414
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008415timeout tunnel <timeout>
8416 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 yes | no | yes | yes
8419 Arguments :
8420 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8421 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8422 as explained at the top of this document.
8423
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008424 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008425 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8426 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8427 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8428 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8429 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8430 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8431 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8432 specified.
8433
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008434 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8435 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8436 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8437 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8438 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8439 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8440 state.
8441
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008442 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8443 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8444 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8445 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8446 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8447
8448 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8449 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8450 forget about it.
8451
8452 Example :
8453 defaults http
8454 option http-server-close
8455 timeout connect 5s
8456 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008457 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008458 timeout server 30s
8459 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8460
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008461 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008462
8463
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008464transparent (deprecated)
8465 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008467 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008468 Arguments : none
8469
8470 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8471 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8472 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8473 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8474 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8475 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8476 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8477 appropriate server.
8478
8479 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8480
8481 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8482 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8483
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008484 See also: "option transparent"
8485
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008486unique-id-format <string>
8487 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | yes | yes | no
8490 Arguments :
8491 <string> is a log-format string.
8492
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008493 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8494 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8495 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8496 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008497
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008498 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8499 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8500 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8501 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8502 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8503 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8504 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8505 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008506
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008507 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8508 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008509
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008510 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008511
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008512 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008513
8514 will generate:
8515
8516 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8517
8518 See also: "unique-id-header"
8519
8520unique-id-header <name>
8521 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8523 yes | yes | yes | no
8524 Arguments :
8525 <name> is the name of the header.
8526
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008527 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8528 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008529
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008530 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008531
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008532 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008533 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8534
8535 will generate:
8536
8537 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8538
8539 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008540
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008541use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008542 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8544 no | yes | yes | no
8545 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008546 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8547 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008548
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008549 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8550 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008551
8552 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8553 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8554 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008555 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8556 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8557 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8558 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008559
8560 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8561 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8562 assign the backend.
8563
8564 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8565 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8566 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8567 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8568 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8569 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8570
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008571 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008572 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008573 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8574 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8575 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8576
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008577 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8578 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8579 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8580 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8581 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8582 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8583 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8584 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8585 cannot be forced from the request.
8586
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008587 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008588 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8589 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8590
8591 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8592 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008593
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008594
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008595use-server <server> if <condition>
8596use-server <server> unless <condition>
8597 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8599 no | no | yes | yes
8600 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008601 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008602
8603 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8604
8605 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8606 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8607 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8608
8609 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8610 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8611 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8612 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8613 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8614 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8615 matches will assign the server.
8616
8617 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8618 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8619 with the next rules until one matches.
8620
8621 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8622 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8623 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8624 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8625
8626 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8627 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8628 stripped.
8629
8630 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8631 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8632 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8633 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8634
8635 Example :
8636 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8637 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8638 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8639 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8640 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8641 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8642 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8643 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8644 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8645
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008646 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008647
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008648
86495. Bind and Server options
8650--------------------------
8651
8652The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8653depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8654settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8655written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8656described in this section.
8657
8658
86595.1. Bind options
8660-----------------
8661
8662The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8663as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8664no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8665parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8666while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8667provided immediately after the setting name.
8668
8669The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8670
8671accept-proxy
8672 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008673 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8674 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008675 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8676 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8677 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8678 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8679 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8680 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8681 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008682 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8683 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008684
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008685alpn <protocols>
8686 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8687 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8688 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8689 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8690 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8691 initial NPN extension.
8692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008693backlog <backlog>
8694 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8695 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8696
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008697ecdhe <named curve>
8698 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008699 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8700 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008701
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008702ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8704 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8705 client's certificate.
8706
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008707ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8709 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8710 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8711 error is ignored.
8712
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008713ciphers <ciphers>
8714 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8715 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008716 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008717 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8718 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8719
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008720crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8722 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8723 to verify client's certificate.
8724
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008725crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8727 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8728 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8729 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8730 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8731 file.
8732
8733 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8734 are loaded.
8735
8736 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008737 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
8738 '.issuer' or '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified
8739 multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
8740 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
8741 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects.
8742 Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the
8743 first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008744 www.sub.example.org).
8745
8746 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8747 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8748 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8749 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01008750 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
8751 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008752
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008753 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008754
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008755 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8756 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008757 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008758 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8759 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8760 clients).
8761
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008762 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8763 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8764 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8765 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8766 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8767 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8768 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8769 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8770 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8771 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8772 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8773 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8774 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8775
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008776crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8778 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008779 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008780 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008781
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008782crt-list <file>
8783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008784 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8785 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008786
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008787 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008788
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008789 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8790 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8791 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8792 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8793 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8794 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8795 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8796 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008797
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008798defer-accept
8799 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8800 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8801 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8802 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8803 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8804 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8805 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8806 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8807 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8808 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8809 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8810
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008811force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008812 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008813 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008814 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8815 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008816
8817force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008818 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008819 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8820 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008821
8822force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008823 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008824 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8825 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008826
8827force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008828 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008829 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8830 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008832gid <gid>
8833 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8834 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8835 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8836 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8837 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8838
8839group <group>
8840 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8841 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8842 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8843 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8844 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8845
8846id <id>
8847 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8848 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8849 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8850 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8851
8852interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008853 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8854 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8855 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8856 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8857 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8858 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8859 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008860
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008861level <level>
8862 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8863 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8864 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8865 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8866 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8867 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8868 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8869 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8870 counters).
8871 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8872 all counters).
8873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008874maxconn <maxconn>
8875 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8876 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8877 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8878 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8879 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8880 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8881 eat all memory.
8882
8883mode <mode>
8884 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8885 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8886 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8887 UNIX sockets.
8888
8889mss <maxseg>
8890 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8891 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8892 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8893 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8894 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8895 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8896 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8897 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8898 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8899 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8900 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8901
8902name <name>
8903 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8904 page.
8905
8906nice <nice>
8907 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8908 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8909 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8910 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8911 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8912 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8913 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8914 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8915 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8916 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8917 one for an RDP socket.
8918
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008919no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008921 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008922 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008923 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8924 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008925 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008926
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008927no-tls-tickets
8928 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8929 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8930 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008931 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8932 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008933
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008934no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008936 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008937 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008938 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8939 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8940 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008941
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008942no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008944 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008945 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008946 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8947 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8948 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008949
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008950no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008952 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008953 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008954 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8955 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8956 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008957
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008958npn <protocols>
8959 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8960 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8961 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8962 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008963 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8964 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008965
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008966process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8967 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8968 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8969 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8970 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8971 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8972 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8973 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008974 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8975 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8976 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8977 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8978 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8979 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8980 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008981
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008982ssl
8983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008984 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008985 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8986 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8987 to deciphered contents.
8988
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008989strict-sni
8990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8991 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8992 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8993 See the "crt" option for more information.
8994
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +01008995tcp-ut <delay>
8996 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
8997 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
8998 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
8999 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
9000 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
9001 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
9002 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
9003 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
9004 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
9005 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
9006 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
9007
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009008tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01009009 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009010 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
9011 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
9012 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
9013 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
9014 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
9015 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
9016 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02009017 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
9018 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
9019 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02009020
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +01009021tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
9022 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
9023 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
9024 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
9025 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
9026 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
9027 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
9028 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
9029 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
9030 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
9031 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
9032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009033transparent
9034 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9035 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
9036 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
9037 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
9038 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
9039 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
9040 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
9041 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
9042 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
9043 so check for support with your vendor.
9044
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009045v4v6
9046 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9047 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
9048 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
9049 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009050 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009051
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009052v6only
9053 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
9054 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
9055 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01009056 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
9057 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01009058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009059uid <uid>
9060 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
9061 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9062 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
9063 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
9064 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9065
9066user <user>
9067 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
9068 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9069 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
9070 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
9071 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9072
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009073verify [none|optional|required]
9074 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
9075 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
9076 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
9077 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
9078 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009079 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
9080 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
9081 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
9082 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009083
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020090845.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009085------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009086
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009087The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
9088which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
9089arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
9090settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
9091after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
9092Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
9093address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009095 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01009096 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009098The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009099
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009100addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009101 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
9102 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
9103 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
9104 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
9105 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009106
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009107 Supported in default-server: No
9108
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009109agent-check
9110 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009111 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
9112 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
9113 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
9114 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009115
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009116 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009117 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02009118 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
9119 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
9120 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009121
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009122 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9123 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009124
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009125 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9126 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
9127 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009128
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009129 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
9130 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
9131 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009132
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009133 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
9134 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
9135 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
9136 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
9137 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
9138 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
9139 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009140
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009141 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
9142 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009143
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009144 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
9145 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
9146 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
9147 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
9148 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
9149 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
9150 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
9151 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
9152 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009153
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009154 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
9155 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009156 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
9157 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
9158 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
9159 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09009160
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01009161 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
9162 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009163
9164 Supported in default-server: No
9165
9166agent-inter <delay>
9167 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
9168 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9169
9170 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
9171 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
9172 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
9173 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
9174 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9175 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9176 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9177 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9178 of backends use the same servers.
9179
9180 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
9181
9182 Supported in default-server: Yes
9183
9184agent-port <port>
9185 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
9186
9187 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
9188
9189 Supported in default-server: Yes
9190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009191backup
9192 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
9193 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
9194 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
9195 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
9196 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
9197 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009199 Supported in default-server: No
9200
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009201ca-file <cafile>
9202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9203 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9204 server's certificate.
9205
9206 Supported in default-server: No
9207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009208check
9209 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01009210 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
9211 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
9212 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
9213 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
9214 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
9215 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
9216 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009217 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
9218 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
9219 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009221 Supported in default-server: No
9222
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009223check-send-proxy
9224 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
9225 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
9226 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
9227 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
9228 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
9229 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
9230 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
9231
9232 Supported in default-server: No
9233
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009234check-ssl
9235 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
9236 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
9237 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
9238 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009239 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009240 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
9241 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
9242 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
9243 See the "ssl" option for more information.
9244
9245 Supported in default-server: No
9246
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009247ciphers <ciphers>
9248 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009249 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009250 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9251 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9252 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9253 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9254 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9255 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9256
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009257 Supported in default-server: No
9258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009259cookie <value>
9260 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9261 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9262 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9263 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9264 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9265 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9266 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9267
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009268 Supported in default-server: No
9269
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009270crl-file <crlfile>
9271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9272 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9273 to verify server's certificate.
9274
9275 Supported in default-server: No
9276
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009277crt <cert>
9278 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9279 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9280 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9281 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9282 certificate request.
9283
9284 Supported in default-server: No
9285
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009286disabled
9287 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9288 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9289 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9290 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9291 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9292
9293 Supported in default-server: No
9294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009295error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009296 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9297 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9298 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009300 Supported in default-server: Yes
9301
9302 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009304fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009305 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9306 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9307 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009309 Supported in default-server: Yes
9310
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009311force-sslv3
9312 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9313 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009314 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9315 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009316
9317 Supported in default-server: No
9318
9319force-tlsv10
9320 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009321 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009323
9324 Supported in default-server: No
9325
9326force-tlsv11
9327 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009328 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9329 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009330
9331 Supported in default-server: No
9332
9333force-tlsv12
9334 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009335 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9336 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009337
9338 Supported in default-server: No
9339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009340id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009341 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9342 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9343 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009345 Supported in default-server: No
9346
9347inter <delay>
9348fastinter <delay>
9349downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009350 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9351 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9352 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9353 between checks depending on the server state :
9354
9355 Server state | Interval used
9356 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9357 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9358 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9359 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9360 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9361 or yet unchecked. |
9362 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9363 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9364 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009366 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9367 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9368 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9369 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009370 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9371 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9372 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9373 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9374 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009376 Supported in default-server: Yes
9377
9378maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009379 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9380 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9381 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9382 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9383 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9384 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9385 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9386 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009388 Supported in default-server: Yes
9389
9390maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009391 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9392 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9393 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9394 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9395 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9396 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9397 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009399 Supported in default-server: Yes
9400
9401minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009402 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9403 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9404 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9405 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9406 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9407 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009408 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009409 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009410
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009411 Supported in default-server: Yes
9412
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +01009413no-ssl-reuse
9414 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
9415 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
9416 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
9417 and for paranoid users.
9418
9419 Supported in default-server: No
9420
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009421no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009422 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9423 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009424 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009425
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009426 Supported in default-server: No
9427
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009428no-tls-tickets
9429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9430 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9431 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009432 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9433 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009434
9435 Supported in default-server: No
9436
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009437no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009438 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009439 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9440 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009441 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9442 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9443 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009444
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009445 Supported in default-server: No
9446
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009447no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009448 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009449 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9450 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009451 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9452 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9453 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009454
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009455 Supported in default-server: No
9456
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009457no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009458 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009459 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9460 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009461 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9462 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9463 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009464
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009465 Supported in default-server: No
9466
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009467non-stick
9468 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9469 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9470 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9471
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009472 Supported in default-server: No
9473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009474observe <mode>
9475 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9476 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9477 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9478 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9479 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9480 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009481 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009483 Supported in default-server: No
9484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009485 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9486
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009487on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009488 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9489 Currently, four modes are available:
9490 - fastinter: force fastinter
9491 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9492 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9493 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9494 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009496 Supported in default-server: Yes
9497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009498 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9499
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009500on-marked-down <action>
9501 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9502 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009503 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9504 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9505 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9506 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9507 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9508 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9509 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9510 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009511
9512 Actions are disabled by default
9513
9514 Supported in default-server: Yes
9515
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009516on-marked-up <action>
9517 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9518 Currently one action is available:
9519 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9520 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9521 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9522 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9523 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9524 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9525 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9526 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9527
9528 Actions are disabled by default
9529
9530 Supported in default-server: Yes
9531
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009532port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009533 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9534 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9535 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9536 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9537 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9538 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9539
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009540 Supported in default-server: Yes
9541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009542redir <prefix>
9543 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9544 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9545 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9546 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9547 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9548 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9549 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9550 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009551 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009552 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9553 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9554 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9555 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9556 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9557
9558 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009560 Supported in default-server: No
9561
9562rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009563 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9564 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9565 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009567 Supported in default-server: Yes
9568
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009569send-proxy
9570 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9571 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9572 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9573 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9574 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9575 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9576 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9577 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9578 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009579 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9580 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9581 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9582 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9583 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009584
9585 Supported in default-server: No
9586
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009587send-proxy-v2
9588 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9589 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9590 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9591 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9592 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9593 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9594 option of the "bind" keyword.
9595
9596 Supported in default-server: No
9597
9598send-proxy-v2-ssl
9599 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9600 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9601 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9602 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9603 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9604 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9605 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9606 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9607
9608 Supported in default-server: No
9609
9610send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9611 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9612 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9613 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9614 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9615 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9616 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9617 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9618 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9619 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9620
9621 Supported in default-server: No
9622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009623slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009624 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9625 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9626 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9627 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9628 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9629 parameters :
9630
9631 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9632 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9633
9634 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9635 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9636 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9637 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9638
9639 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9640 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9641 seen as failed.
9642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009643 Supported in default-server: Yes
9644
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009645source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009646source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009647source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009648 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9649 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9650 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9651 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9652
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009653 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9654 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9655 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9656 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9657 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9658 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9659 server.
9660
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009661 Supported in default-server: No
9662
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009663ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009664 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9665 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9666 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9667 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9668 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9669 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009670 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009671
9672 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009674track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009675 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9676 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9677 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9678 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009679 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009681 Supported in default-server: No
9682
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009683verify [none|required]
9684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009685 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9686 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9687 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9688 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009689 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9690 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9691 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009692
9693 Supported in default-server: No
9694
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009695verifyhost <hostname>
9696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9697 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9698 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9699 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9700 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9701 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9702
9703 Supported in default-server: No
9704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009705weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009706 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9707 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9708 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009709 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9710 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9711 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9712 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9713 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9714 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009716 Supported in default-server: Yes
9717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009718
97196. HTTP header manipulation
9720---------------------------
9721
9722In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9723response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9724request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9725which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009726against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009727
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009728If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9729to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9730but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9731HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9732stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9733because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9734a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9735still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009736
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009737This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9738in section 4.2 :
9739
9740 - reqadd <string>
9741 - reqallow <search>
9742 - reqiallow <search>
9743 - reqdel <search>
9744 - reqidel <search>
9745 - reqdeny <search>
9746 - reqideny <search>
9747 - reqpass <search>
9748 - reqipass <search>
9749 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9750 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9751 - reqtarpit <search>
9752 - reqitarpit <search>
9753 - rspadd <string>
9754 - rspdel <search>
9755 - rspidel <search>
9756 - rspdeny <search>
9757 - rspideny <search>
9758 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9759 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9760
9761With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9762is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9763parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9764prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9765Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9766
9767 \t for a tab
9768 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9769 \n for a new line (LF)
9770 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9771 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9772 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9773 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9774 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9775
9776The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9777portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9778above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9779regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
97809 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9781is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9782
9783The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9784after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9785
9786Notes related to these keywords :
9787---------------------------------
9788 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9789 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9790 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9791
9792 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9793 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9794 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9795
9796 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9797 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9798 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9799 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9800 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9801
9802 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9803 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9804 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9805 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9806 useless headers before adding new ones.
9807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009808 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009809 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9810
9811 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9812 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9813 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9814
9815 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9816 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009817 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009818
9819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098207. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9821----------------------------------
9822
9823Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9824client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9825The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9826these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9827but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9828data called patterns.
9829
9830
98317.1. ACL basics
9832---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009833
9834The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9835content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9836from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9837simple :
9838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009839 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009840 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009841 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9842 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009844The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9845adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009846
9847In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009849 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009850
9851This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9852Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9853and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009854an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9855conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9856as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9857are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009858
9859ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9860'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9861which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9862
9863There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9864performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009866The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9867specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9868this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009869methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9870ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009871
9872Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9873 - boolean
9874 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9875 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9876 - string
9877 - data block
9878
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009879Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9880converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9881would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9882The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9883which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9884
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009885Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9886keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9887fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9888which are summarized in the table below :
9889
9890 +---------------------+-----------------+
9891 | Sample or converter | Default |
9892 | output type | matching method |
9893 +---------------------+-----------------+
9894 | boolean | bool |
9895 +---------------------+-----------------+
9896 | integer | int |
9897 +---------------------+-----------------+
9898 | ip | ip |
9899 +---------------------+-----------------+
9900 | string | str |
9901 +---------------------+-----------------+
9902 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9903 +---------------------+-----------------+
9904
9905Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9906matching method, see below.
9907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009908The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9909 - boolean
9910 - integer or integer range
9911 - IP address / network
9912 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9913 - regular expression
9914 - hex block
9915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009916The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9917
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009918 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9919 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009920 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009921 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009922 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009923 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009924 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009926The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9927read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9928if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9929lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9930will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9931beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9932a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9933lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9934exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9935
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009936The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9937parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9938ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9939a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9940check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9941
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009942The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9943socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9944file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009946Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9947loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9948
9949 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9950
9951In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9952the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9953case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9954as well.
9955
9956The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9957sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9958do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9959methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9960is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9961obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9962followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9963default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9964that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9965string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9966
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009967The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9968By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9969string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9970resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9971server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9972waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9973flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9974function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009976There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9977sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9978be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009979
9980 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9981 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009982 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9983 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9984 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9985 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009986
9987 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9988 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009989 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009990
9991 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009993
9994 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009995 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009996
9997 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9998 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9999
10000 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
10001 binary or string samples.
10002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
10004 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
10007 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
10008 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
10011 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010013 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
10014 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010016 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
10017 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
10020 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010021 This may be used with binary or string samples.
10022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010023 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
10024 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
10025 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020010026
10027For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
10028request, it is possible to do :
10029
10030 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
10031
10032In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
10033buffer, one would use the following acl :
10034
10035 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
10036
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010037On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
10038possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
10039
10040 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
10041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010042All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
10043criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
10044method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
10045to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
10046criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
10047the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010049If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010050the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
10051For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010053 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
10054 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
10055 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
10056 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010057
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020010058
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010059The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
10060types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
10061combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
10062brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
10063default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010065 +-------------------------------------------------+
10066 | Input sample type |
10067 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010068 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010069 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10070 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
10071 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010072 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010074 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010075 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010076 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010077 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010078 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020010080 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010082 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010083 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010084 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010085 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010086 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010088 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010090 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010010092 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
10094 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
10095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010096
10097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200100987.1.1. Matching booleans
10099------------------------
10100
10101In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
10102Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
10103When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
10104that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
10105
10106Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
10107return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
10108"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
10109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101117.1.2. Matching integers
10112------------------------
10113
10114Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
10115enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
10116to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
10117
10118Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
10119matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
10120lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010121
10122For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
10123unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
10124representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
10125
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010126As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
10127two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
10128instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
10129ranges and operators.
10130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010131For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010132operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
10133Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
10134of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010136Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010137
10138 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
10139 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
10140 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
10141 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
10142 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
10143
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010144For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010145
10146 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
10147
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010148This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
10149
10150 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
10151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101537.1.3. Matching strings
10154-----------------------
10155
10156String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
10157different forms :
10158
10159 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
10160 patterns ;
10161
10162 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
10163 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
10164
10165 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
10166 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10167
10168 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
10169 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
10170
10171 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10172 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
10173 matches.
10174
10175 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
10176 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
10177 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010178
10179String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
10180exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
10181characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
10182string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
10183to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010184before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010185
10186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101877.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
10188---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010189
10190Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
10191they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
10192possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
10193passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
10194the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010195the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
10196match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010197
10198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200101997.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
10200-------------------------------------
10201
10202It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
10203not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
10204a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
10205to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
10206digits may be used upper or lower case.
10207
10208Example :
10209 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
10210 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
10211
10212
102137.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
10214---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010215
10216IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
10217netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
10218within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010219host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010220difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
10221at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
10222does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
10223parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010224
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010225IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
10226Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
10227trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
10228IPv6 patterns.
10229
10230HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
10231following situations :
10232 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
10233 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
10234 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
10235 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
10236 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
10237 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
10238 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
10239 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
10240 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
10241 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
10242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010243
102447.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
10245----------------------------------
10246
10247Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
10248combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
10249
10250 - AND (implicit)
10251 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
10252 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010254A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010258Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10259indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10262"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10263requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10264is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10265
10266 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10267 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10268 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10269 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10270
10271To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10272and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10273
10274 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10275 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10276 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10277 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10278
10279 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10280 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10281 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10282 use_backend www if host_www
10283
10284It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10285expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10286be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10287the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10288
10289 The following rule :
10290
10291 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10292 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10293
10294 Can also be written that way :
10295
10296 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10297
10298It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10299to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10300simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10301sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10302good use is the following :
10303
10304 With named ACLs :
10305
10306 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10307 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10308 monitor fail if site_dead
10309
10310 With anonymous ACLs :
10311
10312 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10313
10314See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10315
10316
103177.3. Fetching samples
10318---------------------
10319
10320Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10321against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10322sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10323ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10324of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10325available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10326
10327This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10328Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10329compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10330deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10331
10332The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10333matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10334method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10335indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10336
10337As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10338when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10339mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10340the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10341ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10342
10343Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10344multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10345when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10346incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10347are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10348is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10349all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10350
10351Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10352 - name
10353 - name(arg1)
10354 - name(arg1,arg2)
10355
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010356
103577.3.1. Converters
10358-----------------
10359
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010360Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10361of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10362is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10363was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10364has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10365unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10366
10367These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10368sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10369the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10370support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010371
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010372A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
10373support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
10374supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
10375(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
10376bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
10377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010378The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010380add(<value>)
10381 Adds <value> to the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns the
10382 result as an unsigned integer.
10383
10384and(<value>)
10385 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10386 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10387
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010388base64
10389 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10390 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10391 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010393bool
10394 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10395 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10396 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10397 presence of a flag).
10398
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010399bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10400 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10401 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10402 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10403
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010404cpl
10405 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, applies a twos-complement
10406 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10407
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010408crc32([<avalanche>])
10409 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
10410 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10411 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10412 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10413 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10414 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
10415 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
10416 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
10417 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
10418 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
10419 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
10420
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010421div(<value>)
10422 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10423 result as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
10424 integer is returned (typically 2^32-1).
10425
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010426djb2([<avalanche>])
10427 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10428 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10429 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10430 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10431 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10432 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10433 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010434 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
10435 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010436
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010437even
10438 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is even
10439 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
10440
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010441field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10442 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10443 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10444 list of chars.
10445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010446hex
10447 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10448 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10449 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10450 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010452http_date([<offset>])
10453 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10454 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10455 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10456 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10457 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10458 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010459
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010460in_table(<table>)
10461 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10462 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10463 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10464 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10465 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10466
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010467ipmask(<mask>)
10468 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10469 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10470 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10471 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10472
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010473json([<input-code>])
10474 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10475 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10476 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10477 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10478 of errors:
10479 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10480 bytes, ...)
10481 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10482 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10483
10484 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10485 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10486 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10487 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10488 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10489 are :
10490 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10491 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10492 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10493 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10494 error ;
10495 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10496 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10497
10498 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10499 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10500
10501 Example:
10502 capture request header user-agent len 150
10503 capture request header Host len 15
10504 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10505
10506 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10507 GET / HTTP/1.0
10508 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10509
10510 Output log:
10511 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10512
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010513language(<value>[,<default>])
10514 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10515 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10516 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10517 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10518 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10519 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10520 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10521 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10522 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10523 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10524 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10525 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010527 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010528
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010529 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10530 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010532 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10533 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10534 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10535 use_backend spanish if es
10536 use_backend french if fr
10537 use_backend english if en
10538 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010539
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010540lower
10541 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10542 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10543 type. The result is of type string.
10544
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010545ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10546 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10547 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10548 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10549 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10550 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10551 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10552
10553 Example :
10554
10555 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10556 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10557 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10558
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010559map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10560map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10561map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10562 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10563 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10564 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10565 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10566 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10567 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10568 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10569 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010570
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010571 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10572 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10573 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010575 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10576 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010577
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010578 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10579 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10580 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10581 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010582 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010584 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10586 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10587 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10588 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10589 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10590 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10591 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10592 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10593 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10594 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10595 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10596 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10597 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010599 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10600 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10601 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10602 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10603 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010604
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010605 Example :
10606
10607 # this is a comment and is ignored
10608 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10609 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10610 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10611 | | | `---------- value
10612 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10613 | `---------------------------- key
10614 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10615
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010616mod(<value>)
10617 Divides the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns the
10618 remainder as an unsigned integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
10619
10620mul(<value>)
10621 Multiplies the input value of type unsigned integer by <value>, and returns
10622 the product as an unsigned integer. In case of overflow, the higher bits are
10623 lost, leading to seemingly strange values.
10624
10625neg
10626 Takes the input value of type unsigned integer, computes the opposite value,
10627 and returns the remainder as an unsigned integer. 0 is identity. This
10628 operator is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input
10629 from a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10630
10631not
10632 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type unsigned integer is
10633 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
10634 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
10635 absence of a flag).
10636
10637odd
10638 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type unsigned integer is odd
10639 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
10640
10641or(<value>)
10642 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type unsigned
10643 integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10644
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010010645regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010010646 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
10647 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
10648 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
10649 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
10650 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
10651 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
10652 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
10653 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
10654 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
10655 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
10656 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis or comma
10657 are not possible to use in the arguments. The first use of this converter is
10658 to replace certain characters or sequence of characters with other ones.
10659
10660 Example :
10661
10662 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
10663 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
10664 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
10665 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
10666
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010667sdbm([<avalanche>])
10668 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10669 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10670 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10671 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10672 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10673 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10674 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010675 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
10676 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010677
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010678sub(<value>)
10679 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type unsigned integer, and returns
10680 the result as an unsigned integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
10681 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
10682
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010683table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10687 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10688 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10689 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10690
10691
10692table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10696 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10697 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10698 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10699
10700table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10701 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10702 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10703 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10704 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10705 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10706
10707table_conn_cur(<table>)
10708 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10709 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10710 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10711 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10712 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10713
10714table_conn_rate(<table>)
10715 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10716 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10717 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10718 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10719 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10720
10721table_gpc0(<table>)
10722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10725 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10726 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10727
10728table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10731 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10732 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10733 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10734 sample fetch keyword.
10735
10736table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10740 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10741 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10742
10743table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10744 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10745 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10746 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10747 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10748 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10749 keyword.
10750
10751table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10752 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10753 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10754 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10755 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10756 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10757
10758table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10759 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10760 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10761 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10762 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10763 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10764 keyword.
10765
10766table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10767 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10768 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10769 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10770 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10771 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10772 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10773 keyword.
10774
10775table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10776 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10777 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10778 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10779 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10780 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10781 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10782 keyword.
10783
10784table_server_id(<table>)
10785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10788 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10789 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10790 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10791
10792table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10793 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10794 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10795 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10796 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10797 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10798 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10799 keyword.
10800
10801table_sess_rate(<table>)
10802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10805 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10806 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10807 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10808 keyword.
10809
10810table_trackers(<table>)
10811 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10812 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10813 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10814 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10815 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10816 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10817 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10818 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10819 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10820 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10821
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010822upper
10823 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10824 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10825 type. The result is of type string.
10826
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010827utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10828 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10829 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10830 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10831 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10832 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10833 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10834
10835 Example :
10836
10837 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10838 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10839 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10840
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010841word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10842 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10843 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10844
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010845wt6([<avalanche>])
10846 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10847 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10848 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10849 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10850 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10851 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10852 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010010853 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
10854 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010855
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010010856xor(<value>)
10857 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
10858 of type unsigned integer, and returns the result as an unsigned integer.
10859
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200108617.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010862--------------------------------------------
10863
10864A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10865not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10866"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10867The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10868
10869always_false : boolean
10870 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10871 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10872
10873always_true : boolean
10874 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10875 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10876
10877avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010878 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010879 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10880 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10881 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10882 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10883 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10884 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10885 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10886 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10887 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10888 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10889 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10890 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10891 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010894 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10895 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10896 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10897 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10898 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010900be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10901 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10902 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10903 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10904 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10905 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10906 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010907
10908 Example :
10909 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10910 backend dynamic
10911 mode http
10912 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10913 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10916 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010917 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010918 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10919 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010920
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010921 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010922 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010923 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10924
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010925 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10926 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010927
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010928 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010929 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010930 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010931 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10932 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010933 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010934 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010935
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010936 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10937 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010938 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010939 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010940
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010941date([<offset>]) : integer
10942 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10943 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10944 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10945 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010946 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10947
10948 Example :
10949
10950 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10951 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010952
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010953env(<name>) : string
10954 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10955 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10956 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10957 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10958 certain way.
10959
10960 Examples :
10961 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10962 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10963
10964 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10965 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010967fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10968 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010969 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10970 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010971 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10972 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10973 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10974 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10975 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010977fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10978 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10979 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10980 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10981 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10982 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10983 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10984 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10985 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010986
10987 Example :
10988 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10989 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10990 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10991 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10992 frontend mail
10993 bind :25
10994 mode tcp
10995 maxconn 100
10996 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10997 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10998 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10999 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011000
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011001nbproc : integer
11002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
11003 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
11004 and debugging purposes.
11005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
11007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
11008 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
11009 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011010 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
11011 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
11012 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011013
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011014proc : integer
11015 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
11016 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
11017 debugging purposes.
11018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011019queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011020 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
11021 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
11022 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
11024 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
11025 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
11026 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
11027 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
11028
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010011029rand([<range>]) : integer
11030 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
11031 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
11032 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
11033 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
11034 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
11035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011036srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11037 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11038 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
11039 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
11040 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
11041 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
11042 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
11043 methods.
11044
11045srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
11046 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
11047 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
11048 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
11049 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
11050 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
11051 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
11052 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
11053
11054srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
11055 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
11056 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011057 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011058 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
11059 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
11060 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
11061 overloading servers).
11062
11063 Example :
11064 # Redirect to a separate back
11065 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
11066 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
11067 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
11068
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010011069stopping : boolean
11070 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
11071 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
11072 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
11073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011074table_avl([<table>]) : integer
11075 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
11076 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
11077
11078table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11079 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
11080 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
11081 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
11082
11083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200110847.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011085----------------------------------
11086
11087The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
11088closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
11089methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
11090sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
11091TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011092the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
11093counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
11094"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011095argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
11096the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
11097this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011098
11099be_id : integer
11100 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
11101 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
11102
11103dst : ip
11104 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
11105 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
11106 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
11107 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
11108 RFC 4291.
11109
11110dst_conn : integer
11111 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
11112 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
11113 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
11114 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
11115 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
11116 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
11117 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
11118 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011120dst_port : integer
11121 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
11122 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
11123 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
11124 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
11125 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
11126 an HTTP header.
11127
11128fe_id : integer
11129 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
11130 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
11131 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
11132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011133sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011134sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11135sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11136sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011137 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
11138 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11139 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
11140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011141sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011142sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11143sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11144sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011145 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
11146 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
11147 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
11148
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011149sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011150sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11151sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11152sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011153 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
11154 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011155 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
11156 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
11157 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011158
11159 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11160 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011161 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11162 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
11163 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011164 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11165 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011167sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011168sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11169sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11170sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011171 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
11172 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
11173
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011174sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011175sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11176sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
11177sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011178 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11179 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
11180 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
11181
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011182sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011183sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11184sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11185sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011186 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
11187 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
11188 See also src_conn_rate.
11189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011190sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011191sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11192sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11193sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011194 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011195 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011196
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011197sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011198sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11199sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
11200sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011201 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11202 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
11203 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011204 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11205 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11206 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011208sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011209sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11210sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11211sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011212 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
11213 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
11214 See also src_http_err_cnt.
11215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011216sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011217sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11218sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11219sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011220 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
11221 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11222 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
11223 src_http_err_rate.
11224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011225sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011226sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11227sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11228sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011229 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11230 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11231 src_http_req_cnt.
11232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011233sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011234sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11235sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11236sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011237 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
11238 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
11239 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
11240 src_http_req_rate.
11241
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011242sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011243sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11244sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11245sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011246 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011247 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
11248 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
11249 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
11250 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011251
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011252 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
11253 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011254 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011256sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011257sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11258sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
11259sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011260 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
11261 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11262 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011264sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011265sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11266sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
11267sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011268 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
11269 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
11270 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011272sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011273sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11274sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11275sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011276 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
11277 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
11278 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
11279 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011280 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011281 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
11282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011283sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011284sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11285sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11286sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011287 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
11288 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11289 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
11290 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
11291 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011292 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011294sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011295sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11296sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
11297sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020011298 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
11299 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
11300 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
11301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020011302sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020011303sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11304sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
11305sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011306 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
11307 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011308 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011309 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
11310 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011311 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
11312 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
11313 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010011314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315so_id : integer
11316 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
11317 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
11318 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011320src : ip
11321 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
11322 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
11323 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
11324 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
11325 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
11326 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
11327 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011328
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011329 Example:
11330 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
11331 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
11332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011333src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
11334 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
11335 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
11336 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011337 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011339src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
11340 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
11341 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011342 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011343 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011345src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11346 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11347 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11348 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
11349 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
11350 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
11351 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011352
11353 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
11354 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
11355 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
11356 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011357 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020011358 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
11359 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
11360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011361src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011362 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011363 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011364 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011365 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011367src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011368 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11370 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011371 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011373src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11374 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11375 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11376 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011377 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011380 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011381 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011382 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011383 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011385src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011386 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011387 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011388 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11389 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011390 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11391 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11392 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11395 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11396 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011397 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011398 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011399 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011401src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11402 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11403 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11404 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11405 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011406 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11409 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11410 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11411 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011412 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011414src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11415 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11416 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11417 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011418 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011419 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011421src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11422 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11423 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11424 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011425 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11427 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428
11429 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011430 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011431 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011434 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11435 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11436 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11437 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11438 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011440src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011441 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11442 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11443 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11444 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11445 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011447src_port : integer
11448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11449 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11450 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11451 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011453src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11454 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011455 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11456 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11457 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011458 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11461 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11462 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11463 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11464 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011465 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011467src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11468 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11469 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11470 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11471 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11472 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11473 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11474 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11475 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011476
11477 Example :
11478 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11479 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11480 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11481 listen ssh
11482 bind :22
11483 mode tcp
11484 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011485 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011486 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011487 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011489srv_id : integer
11490 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11491 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11492 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011493
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114957.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011496----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011498The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11499closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11500when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11501usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011502future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011503
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011504ssl_bc : boolean
11505 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11506 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11507 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11508
11509ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11510 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11511 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11512
11513ssl_bc_cipher : string
11514 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11515 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11516
11517ssl_bc_protocol : string
11518 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11519 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11520
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011521ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011522 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011523 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11524 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011525
11526ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11527 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11528 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11529 if session was reused or not.
11530
11531ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11532 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11533 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011535ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11536 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11537 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11538 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11539 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11540 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011542ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11543 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11544 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11545 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11546 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011547
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011548ssl_c_der : binary
11549 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11550 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11551 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011553ssl_c_err : integer
11554 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11555 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11556 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11557 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11558 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11561 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11562 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11563 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11564 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11565 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11566 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11567 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11568 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011570ssl_c_key_alg : string
11571 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11572 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11573 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011575ssl_c_notafter : string
11576 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11577 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11578 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011580ssl_c_notbefore : string
11581 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11582 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11583 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011585ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11586 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11587 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11588 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11589 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11590 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11591 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11592 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11593 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011595ssl_c_serial : binary
11596 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11597 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11598 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011600ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11601 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11602 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11603 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011604 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11605 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11606
11607 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011609ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11610 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11611 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11612 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011614ssl_c_used : boolean
11615 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11616 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011618ssl_c_verify : integer
11619 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11620 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11621 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11622 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011624ssl_c_version : integer
11625 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11626 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011627
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011628ssl_f_der : binary
11629 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11630 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11631 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011633ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11634 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11635 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11636 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11637 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011638 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011639 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11640 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11641 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011643ssl_f_key_alg : string
11644 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11645 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11646 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011648ssl_f_notafter : string
11649 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11650 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11651 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011653ssl_f_notbefore : string
11654 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11655 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11656 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011658ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11659 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11660 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11661 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11662 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11663 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11664 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11665 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11666 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011668ssl_f_serial : binary
11669 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11670 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11671 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011672
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011673ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11674 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11675 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11676 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011678ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11679 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11680 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11681 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011683ssl_f_version : integer
11684 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11685 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11686
11687ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011688 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11689 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11690 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011692 Example :
11693 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11694 listen http-https
11695 bind :80
11696 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11697 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11698
11699ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11700 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11701 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11702
11703ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011704 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011705 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11706 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11707 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11708 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11709 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11710 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11711 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11712 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011714ssl_fc_cipher : string
11715 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11716 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011719 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11720 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011721 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11722 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11723 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11724 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11727 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011728 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11729 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11730 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11731 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011733ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011734 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011735 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11736 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11737 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11738 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11739 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11740 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11741 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011743ssl_fc_protocol : string
11744 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11745 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011746
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011747ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011748 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011749 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11750 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11753 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11754 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11755 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11756 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011758ssl_fc_sni : string
11759 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11760 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11761 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11762 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11763 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11764
11765 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11766 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11767 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011768 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11769 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011771 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011772 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11773 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011775ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11776 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11777 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011778
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011779
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200117807.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011781------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011783Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11784sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11785only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11786For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11787be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11788can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11789sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11790for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11791content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011793payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11794 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11795 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11796 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011798payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11799 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11800 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11801 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011803req.len : integer
11804req_len : integer (deprecated)
11805 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11806 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11807 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11808 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11809 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11810 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11811 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11812 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011814req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11815 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011816 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11817 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11818 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11819 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821 ACL alternatives :
11822 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011824req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11825 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11826 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11827 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11828 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011830 ACL alternatives :
11831 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011833 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835req.proto_http : boolean
11836req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11837 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11838 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11839 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11840 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11841 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11842 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11843 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011845 Example:
11846 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11847 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11848 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011849 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11852rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11853 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11854 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11855 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11856 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11857 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11858 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11859 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11862 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11863 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11864 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11865 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11866 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011868 ACL derivatives :
11869 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871 Example :
11872 listen tse-farm
11873 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11874 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11875 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11876 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11877 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11878 persist rdp-cookie
11879 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11880 # This is only useful makes sense if
11881 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11882 stick-table type string size 204800
11883 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11884 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11885 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11888 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11891rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11892 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11893 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11894 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11895 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897 ACL derivatives :
11898 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11901req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11902 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11903 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11904 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11905 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11906 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11907 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11908 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910req.ssl_sni : string
11911req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11912 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11913 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11914 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11915 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11916 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11917 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11918 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11919 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11920 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11921 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11922 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11923 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011925 ACL derivatives :
11926 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928 Examples :
11929 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11930 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11931 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11932 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11933 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011935res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11936rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11937 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11938 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11939 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11940 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11941 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11942 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11943 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011945req.ssl_ver : integer
11946req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11947 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11948 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11949 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11950 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11951 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11952 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11953 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11954 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11955 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957 ACL derivatives :
11958 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011959
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011960res.len : integer
11961 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11962 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11963 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11964 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11965 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11966 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11967 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11968 content inspection.
11969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011970res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11971 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011972 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11973 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11974 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11975 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11978 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11979 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11980 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11981 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985wait_end : boolean
11986 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11987 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11988 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11989 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11990 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11991 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11992 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11993 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 Examples :
11996 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11997 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11998 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012000 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
12001 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
12002 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
12003 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
12004 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
12005 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
12006 tcp-request content reject
12007
12008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200120097.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012010--------------------------------------
12011
12012It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
12013This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
12014data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
12015its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
12016HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
12017content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
12018to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
12019more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
12020response are indexed.
12021
12022base : string
12023 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
12024 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
12025 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
12026 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
12027 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
12028 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
12029 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
12030 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
12031
12032 ACL derivatives :
12033 base : exact string match
12034 base_beg : prefix match
12035 base_dir : subdir match
12036 base_dom : domain match
12037 base_end : suffix match
12038 base_len : length match
12039 base_reg : regex match
12040 base_sub : substring match
12041
12042base32 : integer
12043 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
12044 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
12045 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012046 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
12047 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
12048 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012049
12050base32+src : binary
12051 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
12052 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
12053 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
12054 per-URL counters.
12055
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012056capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
12057 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
12058 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12059 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
12060
12061capture.req.method : string
12062 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
12063 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
12064 because it's allocated.
12065
12066capture.req.uri : string
12067 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
12068 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
12069 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
12070 allocated.
12071
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012072capture.req.ver : string
12073 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12074 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
12075 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
12076
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010012077capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
12078 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
12079 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
12080 The first entry is an index of 0.
12081 See also: "capture response header"
12082
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020012083capture.res.ver : string
12084 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
12085 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
12086 persistent flag.
12087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012088req.cook([<name>]) : string
12089cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12091 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12092 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
12093 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
12094 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
12095 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
12096 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
12097 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
12098
12099 ACL derivatives :
12100 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
12101 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
12102 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
12103 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
12104 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
12105 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
12106 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
12107 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012109req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12110cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12111 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12112 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012114req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12115cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12116 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12117 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
12118 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
12119 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012121cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12122 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
12123 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
12124 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
12125 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
12126 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
12127 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
12128 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
12129 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
12130 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
12131 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012133hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12134 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
12135 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
12136 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
12137 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012138 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
12141 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12142 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12143 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12144 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12145 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12146 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
12147 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
12148 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012150req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12151 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12152 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12153 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12154 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012156req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12157 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
12158 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
12159 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12160 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12161 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12162 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
12163 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
12164 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
12165 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
12166 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
12167 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169 ACL derivatives :
12170 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12171 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12172 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12173 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12174 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12175 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12176 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12177 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12178
12179req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12180hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
12181 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
12182 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
12183 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
12184 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
12185 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
12186 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
12187 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
12188 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
12189 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
12190
12191req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12192hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12193 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
12194 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
12195 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
12196 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12197 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12198 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12199 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
12200 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
12201
12202req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12203hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12204 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
12205 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
12206 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
12207 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
12208 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
12209 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
12210 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
12211
12212http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
12213 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
12214 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
12215 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12216 basic auth is supported.
12217
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012218http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
12219 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
12220 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
12221 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
12222 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012223 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
12224 basic auth is supported.
12225
12226 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010012227 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
12228 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
12229 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
12230 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231
12232http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012233 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
12234 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
12236 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020012237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238method : integer + string
12239 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
12240 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
12241 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
12242 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
12243 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
12244 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
12245 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247 ACL derivatives :
12248 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012250 Example :
12251 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
12252 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
12253 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012255path : string
12256 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
12257 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
12258 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
12259 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
12260 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
12261 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
12262 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 ACL derivatives :
12265 path : exact string match
12266 path_beg : prefix match
12267 path_dir : subdir match
12268 path_dom : domain match
12269 path_end : suffix match
12270 path_len : length match
12271 path_reg : regex match
12272 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012273
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010012274query : string
12275 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
12276 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
12277 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
12278 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
12279 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
12280 which stops before the question mark.
12281
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012282req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12283 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12284 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12285 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12286 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012288req.ver : string
12289req_ver : string (deprecated)
12290 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
12291 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
12292 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012294 ACL derivatives :
12295 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012297res.comp : boolean
12298 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
12299 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
12300 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012302res.comp_algo : string
12303 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
12304 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
12305 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012307res.cook([<name>]) : string
12308scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12309 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12310 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
12311 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012313 ACL derivatives :
12314 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020012315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012316res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12317scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12318 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
12319 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
12320 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012322res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
12323scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12324 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12325 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
12326 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12329 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12330 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12331 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12332 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12333 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
12334 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
12335 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
12336 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
12337 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012339res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12340 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12341 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12342 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
12343 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
12344 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012346res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
12347shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
12348 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
12349 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
12350 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
12351 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
12352 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
12353 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
12354 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
12355 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012357 ACL derivatives :
12358 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
12359 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
12360 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
12361 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
12362 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
12363 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
12364 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
12365 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
12366
12367res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
12368shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
12369 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
12370 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
12371 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
12372 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
12373 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012375res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
12376shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
12377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12378 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12379 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12380 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12381 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12382 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012383
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010012384res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
12385 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
12386 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
12387 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
12388 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
12389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012390res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12391shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12392 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12393 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12394 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12395 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12396 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12397 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012399res.ver : string
12400resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12401 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12402 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404 ACL derivatives :
12405 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012407set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12408 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12409 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12410 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12411 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012413 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12414 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012416 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012418status : integer
12419 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12420 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12421 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012423url : string
12424 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12425 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12426 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12427 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12428 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12429 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12430 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012432 ACL derivatives :
12433 url : exact string match
12434 url_beg : prefix match
12435 url_dir : subdir match
12436 url_dom : domain match
12437 url_end : suffix match
12438 url_len : length match
12439 url_reg : regex match
12440 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012442url_ip : ip
12443 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12444 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12445 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12446 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12447 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12448 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12449 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012451url_port : integer
12452 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12453 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12454 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12455 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012457urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12458url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12459 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12460 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12461 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12462 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12463 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12464 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12465 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12466 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12467 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469 ACL derivatives :
12470 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12471 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12472 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12473 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12474 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12475 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12476 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12477 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012478
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012480 Example :
12481 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12482 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12483 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12484 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012486urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12487 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12488 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12489 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012490
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012493---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012494
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012495Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12496every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012497order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012498
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012499ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12500---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012501FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012502HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012503HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12504HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012505HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12506HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12507HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12508HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12509LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012510METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12511METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12512METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12513METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12514METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12515METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012516RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012517REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012518TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012519WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12520---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012521
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125238. Logging
12524----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012525
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012526One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12527provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12528very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12529provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12530state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012531to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012532headers.
12533
12534In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12535about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12536send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12537
12538 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12539 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12540 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12541 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12542 at the termination.
12543
12544The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12545allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12546as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12547while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12548real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12549delay.
12550
12551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125528.1. Log levels
12553---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012554
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012555TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012556source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012557HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12558in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12559track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12560syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12561about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012562
12563
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125648.2. Log formats
12565----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012566
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012567HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012568and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12569slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12570options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012571
12572 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12573 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12574 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12575 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12576 extents.
12577
12578 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12579 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12580 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12581 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12582 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12583
12584 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12585 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12586 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12587 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12588 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12589
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012590 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12591 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12592 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12593 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12594
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012595 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12596
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012597Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12598specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12599field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12600servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12601always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12602identifier.
12603
12604Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12605 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12606 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12607 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12608 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12609
12610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126118.2.1. Default log format
12612-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012613
12614This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12615as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12616format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12617
12618 Example :
12619 listen www
12620 mode http
12621 log global
12622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12623
12624 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12625 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12626 (www/HTTP)
12627
12628 Field Format Extract from the example above
12629 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12630 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12631 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12632 4 'to' to
12633 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12634 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12635
12636Detailed fields description :
12637 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12638 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12639 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12640 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12641 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12642 and processed the connection.
12643 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12644
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012645In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12646"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12647connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12648
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012649It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12650will eventually disappear.
12651
12652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126538.2.2. TCP log format
12654---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012655
12656The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12657is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12658information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12659counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12660emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12661environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12662the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12663sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012664specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12665not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12666fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12667marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012668
12669 Example :
12670 frontend fnt
12671 mode tcp
12672 option tcplog
12673 log global
12674 default_backend bck
12675
12676 backend bck
12677 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12678
12679 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12680 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12681 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12682
12683 Field Format Extract from the example above
12684 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12685 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12686 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12687 4 frontend_name fnt
12688 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12689 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12690 7 bytes_read* 212
12691 8 termination_state --
12692 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12693 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12694
12695Detailed fields description :
12696 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012697 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12698 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12699 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12700 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12701 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012702
12703 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012704 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12705 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12706 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012707
12708 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12709 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12710 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12711 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12712
12713 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12714 and processed the connection.
12715
12716 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12717 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12718 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12719 applications.
12720
12721 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12722 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12723 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12724 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12725 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12726
12727 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12728 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12729 See "Timers" below for more details.
12730
12731 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12732 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12733 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12734 "Timers" below for more details.
12735
12736 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012737 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012738 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12739 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12740 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12741 details.
12742
12743 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12744 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12745 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12746 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12747 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12748
12749 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12750 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12751 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12752 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12753 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12754 for more details.
12755
12756 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012757 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012758 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12759 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12760 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012761 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012762
12763 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12764 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12765 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12766 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12767 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12768 caused by a denial of service attack.
12769
12770 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12771 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12772 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12773 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12774 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12775 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12776 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12777 denial of service attack.
12778
12779 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12780 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12781 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12782 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12783 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12784 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12785 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12786 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12787 be processed than on other servers.
12788
12789 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12790 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12791 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12792 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12793 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12794 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12795 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12796 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12797 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12798 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12799 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12800 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12801 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12802
12803 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12804 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12805 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12806 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12807 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12808 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12809 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12810 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12811
12812 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12813 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12814 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12815 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12816 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12817 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12818 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12819 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12820 occurs.
12821
12822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128238.2.3. HTTP log format
12824----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012825
12826The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12827is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12828the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12829are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12830emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12831generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12832"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12833which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012834frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12835is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012836
12837Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12838slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12839with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12840
12841 Example :
12842 frontend http-in
12843 mode http
12844 option httplog
12845 log global
12846 default_backend bck
12847
12848 backend static
12849 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12850
12851 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12852 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12853 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012854 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012855
12856 Field Format Extract from the example above
12857 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12858 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12859 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12860 4 frontend_name http-in
12861 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12862 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12863 7 status_code 200
12864 8 bytes_read* 2750
12865 9 captured_request_cookie -
12866 10 captured_response_cookie -
12867 11 termination_state ----
12868 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12869 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12870 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12871 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12872 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012874
12875Detailed fields description :
12876 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012877 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12878 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12879 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12880 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12881 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012882
12883 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012884 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12885 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12886 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012887
12888 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12889 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12890 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12891 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12892 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12893
12894 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12895 and processed the connection.
12896
12897 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12898 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12899 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12900
12901 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12902 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12903 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12904 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12905 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12906 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12907
12908 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12909 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12910 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12911 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12912 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12913 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12914
12915 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12916 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12917 See "Timers" below for more details.
12918
12919 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12920 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12921 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12922 below for more details.
12923
12924 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12925 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12926 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12927 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12928 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12929 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12930 for more details.
12931
12932 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012933 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012934 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12935 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12936 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12937 details.
12938
12939 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12940 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12941 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12942
12943 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12944 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12945 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12946 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12947 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12948 overflowing.
12949
12950 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12951 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12952 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12953 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12954 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12955 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12956 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12957 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12958
12959 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12960 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12961 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12962 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12963 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12964 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12965 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12966 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12967
12968 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12969 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12970 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12971 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12972 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12973 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12974 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12975
12976 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012977 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012978 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12979 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12980 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012981 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012982 system.
12983
12984 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12985 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12986 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12987 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12988 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12989 caused by a denial of service attack.
12990
12991 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12992 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12993 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12994 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12995 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12996 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12997 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12998 denial of service attack.
12999
13000 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
13001 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
13002 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
13003 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
13004 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
13005 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
13006 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
13007 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
13008 processed than on other servers.
13009
13010 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
13011 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
13012 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
13013 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
13014 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
13015 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
13016 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
13017 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
13018 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
13019 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
13020 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
13021 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
13022 should not be attributed to the logged server.
13023
13024 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13025 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
13026 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
13027 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
13028 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
13029 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
13030 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
13031 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
13032
13033 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
13034 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
13035 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
13036 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
13037 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
13038 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
13039 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
13040 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
13041 occurs.
13042
13043 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
13044 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
13045 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
13046 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
13047 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
13048 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
13049 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
13050 cookies" below for more details.
13051
13052 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
13053 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
13054 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
13055 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
13056 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
13057 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
13058 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
13059 and cookies" below for more details.
13060
13061 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
13062 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
13063 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
13064 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
13065 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
13066 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
13067 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
13068 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
13069
13070
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200130718.2.4. Custom log format
13072------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013073
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013074The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013075mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013076
13077HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
13078Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
13079separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
13080prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
13081
13082Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
13083variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
13084string formats ("Q").
13085
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013086If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020013087as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010013088less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
13089the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
13090
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013091Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013092In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010013093in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013094
13095Flags are :
13096 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013097 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013098
13099 Example:
13100
13101 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
13102 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
13103
13104At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
13105
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013106 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
13107 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013108
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013109the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013110
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013111 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013112 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013113 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013114
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013115and the default TCP format is defined this way :
13116
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013117 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013118 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
13119
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013120Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
13121
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013122 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013123 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013124 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
13125 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
13126 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013127 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
13128 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
13129 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013130 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013131 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020013132 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013133 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013134 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080013135 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013136 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
13137 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013138 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013139 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
13140 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013141 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013142 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
13143 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013144 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13145 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
13146 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013147 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013148 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
13149 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013150 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013151 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
13152 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
13153 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020013154 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020013155 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013156 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
13157 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
13158 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
13159 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013160 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020013161 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013162 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013163 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010013164 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013165 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013166 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
13167 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
13168 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013169 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013170 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
13171 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010013172 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013173 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013174 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010013175 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013176
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020013177 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010013178
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010013179
131808.2.5. Error log format
13181-----------------------
13182
13183When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
13184protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
13185By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
13186"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
13187will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
13188logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
13189
13190The format looks like this :
13191
13192 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
13193 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
13194 Connection error during SSL handshake
13195
13196 Field Format Extract from the example above
13197 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
13198 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
13199 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
13200 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
13201 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
13202
13203These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
13204failures.
13205
13206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132078.3. Advanced logging options
13208-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013209
13210Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
13211just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
13212options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
13213for more information about their usage.
13214
13215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132168.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
13217------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013218
13219It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
13220haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
13221commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
13222monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
13223ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
13224
13225 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
13226 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
13227 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
13228 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
13229
13230 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
13231 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
13232 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013233 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013234 such as other load-balancers.
13235
13236 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
13237 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
13238 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
13239
13240
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132418.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
13242----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013243
13244The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
13245what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
13246or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
13247"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
13248just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
13249log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
13250after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
13251is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
13252with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
13253with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
13254
13255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132568.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
13257------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013258
13259Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
13260for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
13261"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
13262retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
13263raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
13264a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
13265file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
13266you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
13267"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
13268
13269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132708.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
13271--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020013272
13273Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
13274multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
13275them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
13276"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
13277logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
13278error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
13279and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
13280too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
13281useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
13282alternative.
13283
13284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200132858.4. Timing events
13286------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013287
13288Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
13289reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
13290the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
13291frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
13292mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
13293
13294 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
13295 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
13296 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
13297 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
13298 the client closes prematurely or times out.
13299
13300 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
13301 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
13302 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
13303 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
13304 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
13305
13306 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
13307 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
13308 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
13309 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
13310 connection never established.
13311
13312 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
13313 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
13314 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
13315 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
13316 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
13317 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
13318 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
13319 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
13320 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
13321 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
13322 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
13323
13324 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
13325 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
13326 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
13327 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013328 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013329
13330 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
13331
13332 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
13333 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
13334 negative.
13335
13336These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
13337protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
13338that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013339due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013340close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
13341session has been aborted on timeout.
13342
13343Most common cases :
13344
13345 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13346 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
13347 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
13348 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
13349 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
13350 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
13351 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
13352 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
13353 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020013354 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
13355 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
13356 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013357
13358 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
13359 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
13360 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
13361 of ms on remote networks.
13362
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013363 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
13364 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
13365 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013366
13367 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
13368 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
13369 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
13370 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
13371 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
13372 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
13373 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
13374 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
13375 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
13376 to the server until another one is released.
13377
13378Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
13379
13380 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
13381 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
13382 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
13383
13384 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13385 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13386 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13387
13388 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13389 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13390 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13391 flags.
13392
13393 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13394 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13395 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13396 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13397 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13398 the client connection was maintained open.
13399
13400 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013401 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013402 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13403 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13404
13405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134068.5. Session state at disconnection
13407-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013408
13409TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13410"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
134112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13412each of which has a special meaning :
13413
13414 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13415 session to terminate :
13416
13417 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13418
13419 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13420 server explicitly refused it.
13421
13422 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13423 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13424 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13425 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013426 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13427
13428 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13429 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013430
13431 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13432 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13433 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13434 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13435 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13436
13437 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13438 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13439 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13440 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13441 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13442
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013443 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13444 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13445
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013446 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13447 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13448 backup connections when going up.
13449
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013450 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13451
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013452 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13453 send or receive data.
13454
13455 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13456 send or receive data.
13457
13458 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13459 with nothing left in the buffers.
13460
13461 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13462
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013463 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013464 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13465
13466 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13467 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13468 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13469 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13470 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13471
13472 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13473 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13474
13475 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13476 server (HTTP only).
13477
13478 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13479
13480 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13481 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13482 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13483
13484 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13485 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13486 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13487
13488 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13489
13490 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13491 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13492
13493 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13494 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13495 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13496
13497 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13498 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013499 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13500 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013501
13502 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13503 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13504 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13505 another server.
13506
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013507 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013508 server.
13509
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013510 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13511 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13512 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13513 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13514
13515 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13516 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13517 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13518 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13519
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013520 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13521 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13522 "use-server" rule).
13523
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013524 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13525
13526 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13527 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13528
13529 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13530
13531 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13532 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13533 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13534
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013535 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13536 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013537 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013538 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13539 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13540
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013541 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13542
13543 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13544 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13545
13546 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13547
13548 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13549
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013550The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13551was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013552helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13553starvation, attacks, etc...
13554
13555The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13556alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13557easier finding and understanding.
13558
13559 Flags Reason
13560
13561 -- Normal termination.
13562
13563 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13564 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13565 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13566 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13567
13568 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13569 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13570 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13571 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13572 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13573 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013575 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13576 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013577 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013578
13579 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13580 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13581 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13582
13583 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13584 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13585 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13586 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13587 the server takes too long to respond.
13588
13589 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13590 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13591 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13592 long a time to respond.
13593
13594 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13595 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13596 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13597 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13598 and the client.
13599
13600 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13601 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13602 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13603 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13604 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013605 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13606 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13607 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13608 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13609 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13610 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13611 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13612 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13613 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13614 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13615 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13616 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13617 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13618 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013619
13620 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13621 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013622 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13623 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13624 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13625 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013626
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013627 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13628 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013630 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013631 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13632 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13633 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13634 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13635 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13636
13637 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13638 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13639 503 or 504 here.
13640
13641 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13642 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13643 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13644 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13645 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13646
13647 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13648 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013649 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013650 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13651 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13652
13653 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13654 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13655 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13656 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13657 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13658 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13659 between haproxy and the server.
13660
13661 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13662 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13663 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13664 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13665 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13666 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13667 solution is to fix the application.
13668
13669 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13670 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13671 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13672 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13673 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13674 external attacks.
13675
13676 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13677 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013678 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013679 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13680 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13681
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013682 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13683 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13684 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013685 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13686 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013687
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013688 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13689 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13690 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13691 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013692 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13693 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13694 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13695 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13696 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013697
13698 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13699 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13700 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13701 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13702
13703 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13704 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13705 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13706 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13707
13708 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13709 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13710 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13711 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13712
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013713The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13714persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13715important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13716re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13717
13718 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13719
13720 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13721 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13722 set on a GET request.
13723
13724 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13725 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013726 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013727 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13728
13729 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13730 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13731 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13732
13733 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13734 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13735 already got a cookie.
13736
13737 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13738 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13739 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13740 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13741 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13742
13743 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13744 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13745 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13746
13747 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13748 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13749 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13750
13751 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13752 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13753
13754 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13755 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13756 then advertised in the response.
13757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137598.6. Non-printable characters
13760-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013761
13762In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13763consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13764converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13765prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13766being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13767escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13768is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13769'}' when logging headers.
13770
13771Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13772issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13773containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13774
13775Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13776the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13777performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13778
13779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137808.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13781---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013782
13783Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13784achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013785section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013786cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13787the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13788the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013789locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013790not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13791user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13792a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13793wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13794
13795 Examples :
13796 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13797 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13798
13799 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13800 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13801
13802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13804---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013805
13806Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13807proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13808the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13809server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13810
13811Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13812response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013813section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013814
13815It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013816time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13817appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013818are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13819and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13820follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13821request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13822in the logs.
13823
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013824As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13825frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13826an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13827
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013828 Example :
13829 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13830 listen proxy-out
13831 mode http
13832 option httplog
13833 option logasap
13834 log global
13835 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13836
13837 # log the name of the virtual server
13838 capture request header Host len 20
13839
13840 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13841 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13842
13843 # log the beginning of the referrer
13844 capture request header Referer len 20
13845
13846 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13847 capture response header Server len 20
13848
13849 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13850 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13851
13852 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13853 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13854
13855 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13856 capture response header Via len 20
13857
13858 # log the URL location during a redirection
13859 capture response header Location len 20
13860
13861 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13862 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13863 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13864 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13865 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13866
13867 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13868 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13869 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13870 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013871 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013872
13873 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13874 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13875 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13876 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13877 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013878 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013879
13880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138818.9. Examples of logs
13882---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013883
13884These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13885them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13886reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13887
13888 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13889 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13890 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13891
13892 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13893 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13894
13895 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13896 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13897 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13898
13899 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13900 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13901
13902 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13903 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13904 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13905
13906 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013907 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013908 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13909 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13910
13911 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13912 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13913 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13914
13915 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13916 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013917 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013918 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13919 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13920 to return the 502 and not the server.
13921
13922 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013923 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013924
13925 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13926 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13927 Nothing was sent to any server.
13928
13929 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13930 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13931
13932 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13933 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13934 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13935 send a 408 return code to the client.
13936
13937 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13938 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13939
13940 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13941 5 seconds ("c----").
13942
13943 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13944 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013945 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013946
13947 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013948 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013949 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13950 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13951 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13952 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13953 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013954
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139569. Statistics and monitoring
13957----------------------------
13958
13959It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13960mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13961CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13962Unix socket.
13963
13964
139659.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013966---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013967
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013968The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013969page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13970begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13971represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13972use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13973('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13974(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13975text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13976do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13977use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013978
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013979In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13980that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13981S (Servers).
13982
13983 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13984 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13985 any name for server/listener)
13986 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13987 number queued without a server assigned.
13988 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13989 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13990 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13991 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13992 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13993 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13994 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13995 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13996 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13997 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13998 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13999 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
14000 "option checkcache".
14001 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
14002 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
14003 - read error from the client
14004 - client timeout
14005 - client closed connection
14006 - various bad requests from the client.
14007 - request was tarpitted.
14008 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
14009 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
14010 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
14011 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
14012 active servers).
14013 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
14014 Some other errors are:
14015 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
14016 - failure applying filters to the response.
14017 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
14018 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
14019 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
14020 switched away from.
14021 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
14022 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
14023 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
14024 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
14025 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
14026 the server is up.)
14027 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
14028 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
14029 counters for each server.
14030 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
14031 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
14032 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
14033 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
14034 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
14035 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
14036 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
14037 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
14038 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
14039 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
14040 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
14041 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
14042 of times that server was selected.
14043 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
14044 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
14045 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
14046 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
14047 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
14048 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014049 UNK -> unknown
14050 INI -> initializing
14051 SOCKERR -> socket error
14052 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
14053 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
14054 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
14055 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
14056 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
14057 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
14058 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
14059 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
14060 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
14061 disable-on-404
14062 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
14063 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
14064 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040014065 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
14066 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
14067 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
14068 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
14069 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
14070 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
14071 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
14072 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
14073 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
14074 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
14075 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
14076 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
14077 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
14078 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
14079 (inc. in eresp)
14080 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
14081 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
14082 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
14083 (CPU/BW limit)
14084 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
14085 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
14086 server/backend
14087 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
14088 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
14089 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14090 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14091 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
14092 (0 for TCP)
14093 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
14094 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014095
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140979.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014098-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014099
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014100The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
14101necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
14102A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
14103issuing commands by hand :
14104
14105 global
14106 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14107 stats timeout 2m
14108
14109It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
14110the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
14111never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
14112situations :
14113
14114 global
14115 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
14116 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
14117 stats timeout 2m
14118
14119To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
14120swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
14121to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
14122syntaxes we'll use are the following :
14123
14124 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
14125 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
14126
14127The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
14128script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
14129for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
14130
14131The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
14132that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
14133editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
14134(eg: watch a counter).
14135
14136The socket supports two operation modes :
14137 - interactive
14138 - non-interactive
14139
14140The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
14141this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
14142sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
14143mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
14144commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
14145example :
14146
14147 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
14148
14149The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
14150entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
14151for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
14152sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
14153"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
14154after processing the last command of the same line.
14155
14156For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
14157"prompt" command :
14158
14159 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
14160 prompt
14161 > show info
14162 ...
14163 >
14164
14165Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
14166delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
14167that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
14168parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014169
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014170It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
14171on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
14172own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014173
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020014174The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
14175If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
14176all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
14177it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
14178
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014179add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014180 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
14181 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
14182 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
14183 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014184
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014185add map <map> <key> <value>
14186 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
14187 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014188 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
14189 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
14190 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014192clear counters
14193 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
14194 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
14195 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
14196 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
14197 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14198
14199clear counters all
14200 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
14201 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
14202 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
14203
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014204clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014205 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
14206 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
14207 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014208
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014209clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014210 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
14211 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
14212 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014213
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014214clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
14215 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
14216
14217 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
14218 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
14219 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
14220 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
14221 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
14222 later after the session ends is usual enough.
14223
14224 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
14225
14226 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
14227 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
14228 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
14229 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
14230 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
14231 the ACLs :
14232
14233 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14234 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14235 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14236 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14237 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14238 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14239
14240 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014241 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
14242 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014243
14244 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014245 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014246 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014247 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14248 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14249 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14250 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014251
14252 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14253
14254 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020014255 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014256 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14257 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014258 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14259 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14260 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014261
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014262del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
14263 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014264 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
14265 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14266 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
14267 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014268
14269del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014270 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014271 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
14272 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
14273 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
14274 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010014275
14276disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014277 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
14278
14279 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
14280 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
14281 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
14282 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
14283 re-enabled using enable agent.
14284
14285 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
14286 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
14287 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
14288 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
14289 otherwise unchanged.
14290
14291 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
14292 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
14293 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
14294
14295 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14296 level "admin".
14297
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014298disable frontend <frontend>
14299 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
14300 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
14301 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
14302 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
14303 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
14304 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
14305 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
14306 on the stats page.
14307
14308 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14309 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14310
14311 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14312 level "admin".
14313
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014314disable health <backend>/<server>
14315 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
14316 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
14317 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
14318 agent check forces it down.
14319
14320 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14321 level "admin".
14322
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014323disable server <backend>/<server>
14324 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
14325 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
14326 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
14327 during the maintenance.
14328
14329 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
14330 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
14331
14332 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014333 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014334
14335 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14336 level "admin".
14337
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090014338enable agent <backend>/<server>
14339 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
14340
14341 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
14342 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
14343
14344 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14345 level "admin".
14346
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014347enable frontend <frontend>
14348 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
14349 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
14350 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
14351 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
14352 which was disabled.
14353
14354 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14355 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14356
14357 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14358 level "admin".
14359
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020014360enable health <backend>/<server>
14361 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
14362 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
14363
14364 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14365 level "admin".
14366
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014367enable server <backend>/<server>
14368 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
14369 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
14370
14371 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014372 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014373
14374 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14375 level "admin".
14376
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014377get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014378get acl <acl> <value>
14379 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
14380 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
14381 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
14382 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
14383 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014384
14385 The first two words are:
14386
14387 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14388 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14389 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14390
14391 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14392
14393 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14394
14395 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14396
14397 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14398 interpretation of the case.
14399
14400 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14401 useful with regular expressions.
14402
14403 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14404 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14405
14406 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14407 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14408 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14409
14410 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14411
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014412get weight <backend>/<server>
14413 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14414 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14415 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14416 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14417 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014418 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014419
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014420help
14421 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14422 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014423
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014424prompt
14425 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14426 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14427 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14428 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14429 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14430 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14431 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14432 command.
14433
14434quit
14435 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014436
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014437set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014438 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14439 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14440 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014441
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014442set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014443 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14444 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14445 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14446 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14447 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014448 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14449 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14450
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014451set maxconn global <maxconn>
14452 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14453 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14454 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14455 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14456 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14457 setting.
14458
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014459set rate-limit connections global <value>
14460 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14461 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14462 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14463 is passed in number of connections per second.
14464
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014465set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14466 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14467 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014468 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14469 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014470
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014471set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14472 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14473 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14474 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14475 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14476
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014477set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14478 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14479 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14480 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14481 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14482 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14483
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014484set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14485 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14486 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14487 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14488
14489set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14490 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14491 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14492 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14493
14494set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14495 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14496 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14497 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14498 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14499 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14500 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14501 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14502 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14503
14504set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14505 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14506 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14507
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014508set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14509 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14510 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14511 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14512 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14513
14514 Example:
14515 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14516 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14517 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14518 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14519
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014520set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014521 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14522 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14523 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14524 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014525 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14526 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014527
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014528set timeout cli <delay>
14529 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14530 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14531 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14532
14533set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14534 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14535 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014536 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14537 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14538 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14539 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14540 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14541 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14542 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14543 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14544 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14545 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14546 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14547 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14548 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014549
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014550show errors [<iid>]
14551 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14552 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014553 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14554 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14555 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014556
14557 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14558 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14559 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14560 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14561 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14562 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14563 are reported too.
14564
14565 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14566 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14567 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14568 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14569 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14570 code.
14571
14572 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14573 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14574 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14575 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14576 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14577 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14578 line.
14579
14580 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014581 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14582 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014583 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14584 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14585
14586 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14587 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14588 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14589 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14590 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14591 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14592 00204+ minal\r\n
14593 00211 \r\n
14594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014595 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014596 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14597 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14598 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14599 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14600 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14601 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014602
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014603show info
14604 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14605
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014606show map [<map>]
14607 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014608 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14609 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14610 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14611 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14612 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14613 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014614
14615show acl [<acl>]
14616 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014617 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14618 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14619 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14620 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14621 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014622
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014623show pools
14624 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14625 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14626 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14627 the pools.
14628
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014629show sess
14630 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014631 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14632 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14633
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014634show sess <id>
14635 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14636 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14637 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14638 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14639 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014640 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14641 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14642
14643 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14644 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014645
14646show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14647 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14648 possible to dump only selected items :
14649 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14650 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14651 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14652 for example:
14653 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14654 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14655 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14656
14657 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014658 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14659 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014660 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14661 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14662 Nbproc: 1
14663 Process_num: 1
14664 (...)
14665
14666 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14667 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14668 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14669 (...)
14670 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14671
14672 $
14673
14674 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14675 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14676 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14677 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014678 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014679
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014680show table
14681 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14682 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14683 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14684 entries currently in use.
14685
14686 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014687 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014688 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14689 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014690
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014691show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014692 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14693 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14694 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014695 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14696
14697 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14698 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14699 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14700 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14701 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14702
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014703 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14704 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14705 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14706 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14707 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14708 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14709
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014710
14711 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014712 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14713 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014714
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014715 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014716 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014717 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014718 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14719 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14720 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14721 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014722
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014723 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014724 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014725 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14726 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014727
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014728 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14729 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014730 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014731 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14732 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014733
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014734 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14735 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014736 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014737 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14738 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14739
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014740 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14741 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14742 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14743 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14744 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14745
14746 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14747 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14748 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014749 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14750 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014751 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14752 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014753
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014754shutdown frontend <frontend>
14755 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14756 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14757 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14758 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14759 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14760 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14761 once it is terminated.
14762
14763 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14764 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14765
14766 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14767 level "admin".
14768
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014769shutdown session <id>
14770 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14771 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14772 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14773 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14774 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14775 flag in the logs.
14776
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014777shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014778 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14779 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14780 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14781 'K' flag in the logs.
14782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014783/*
14784 * Local variables:
14785 * fill-column: 79
14786 * End:
14787 */